arm_tpiu_swo: add support for independent TPIU and SWO
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex zy1000
302 @cindex printer port
303 @cindex USB Adapter
304 @cindex RTCK
305
306 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
307 an adapter .... [snip]
308
309 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
310 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
311 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
312 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
313 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
314 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
315 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
316
317
318 @section Choosing a Dongle
319
320 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
321
322 @enumerate
323 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
324 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
325 other ways to communicate with target devices.
326 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
327 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
328 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
329 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
330 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
331 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
332 Ethernet port needed?
333 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
334 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
335 @end enumerate
336
337 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
338
339 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
340 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
341 running on the developer's host computer.
342 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
343 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
344 IP address assigned to the probe.
345 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
346 OpenOCD debugger.
347 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
348 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
349 the target.
350 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
351 to power cycle the target remotely.
352
353 For more information, visit:
354
355 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
356
357 @section USB FT2232 Based
358
359 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
360 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
361 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
362 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
363 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
364 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
365 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
366 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
367 clocking.)
368
369 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
370 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
371 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
372 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
373 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
374
375 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
376 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
377
378 @itemize @bullet
379 @item @b{usbjtag}
380 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
381 @item @b{jtagkey}
382 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
383 @item @b{jtagkey2}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
385 @item @b{oocdlink}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
387 @item @b{signalyzer}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
389 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
391 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
392 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
393 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
394 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
395 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
396 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
397 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
398 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
399 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
400 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
401 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
402 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
404 @item @b{turtelizer2}
405 @* See:
406 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
407 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
408 @item @b{comstick}
409 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
410 @item @b{stm32stick}
411 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
412 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
413 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
414 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
415 @item @b{cortino}
416 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
417 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
419 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
421 @item @b{opendous}
422 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
423 (OpenHardware).
424 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
425 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
426
427 @item @b{GW16042}
428 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
429 FT2232H-based
430
431 @end itemize
432 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
433
434 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
435 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
436 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
437 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
438 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
439
440 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
441 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
442 (see the section on driver commands).
443
444 @itemize
445 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
446 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
447 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
448 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
449 @end itemize
450
451 @section USB J-Link based
452 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
453 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
454 AT91SAM764 internally.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
458 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
459 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
461 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
462 @end itemize
463
464 @section USB RLINK based
465 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
466 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
467 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
468
469 @itemize @bullet
470 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
472 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
476 @end itemize
477
478 @section USB ST-LINK based
479 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
480 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
481
482 @itemize @bullet
483 @item @b{ST-LINK}
484 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
485 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
486 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
489 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
508 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
509 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
510 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
511 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
512
513 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
514 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
515 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
516
517 @section USB Other
518 @itemize @bullet
519 @item @b{USBprog}
520 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
521
522 @item @b{USB - Presto}
523 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
524
525 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
526 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
527
528 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
529 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
530
531 @item @b{Buspirate}
532 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
533
534 @item @b{opendous}
535 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
536
537 @item @b{estick}
538 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
539
540 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
541 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
542
543 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
544 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
546 @end itemize
547
548 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
549
550 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
551 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
552 these on the market.
553
554 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
555 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
556 of USB-based ones.
557
558 @itemize @bullet
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
562
563 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
564 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
565 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
566
567 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler2}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
574 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
575
576 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
577 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
578
579 @item @b{arm-jtag}
580 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
581
582 @item @b{chameleon}
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
584
585 @item @b{Triton}
586 @* Unknown.
587
588 @item @b{Lattice}
589 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
590 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
591
592 @item @b{flashlink}
593 @* From STMicroelectronics;
594 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
595
596 @end itemize
597
598 @section Other...
599 @itemize @bullet
600
601 @item @b{ep93xx}
602 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
603
604 @item @b{at91rm9200}
605 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
606
607 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
608 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
609
610 @item @b{imx_gpio}
611 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
612
613 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
614 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
615 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
616
617 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
618 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
619 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
620 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
621 emulation model of target hardware.
622
623 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
624 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
625
626 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
627 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
628
629 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
630 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
631 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
632
633 @end itemize
634
635 @node About Jim-Tcl
636 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
637 @cindex Jim-Tcl
638 @cindex tcl
639
640 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
641 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
642 command interpreter.
643
644 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
645 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
646 much of anything about Tcl.
647 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
648
649 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
650 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
651 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
652 OpenOCD mailing list.
653
654 @itemize @bullet
655 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
656 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
657 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
658 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
659 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
660 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
661
662 @item @b{Missing Features}
663 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
664 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
665 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
666 enabled in OpenOCD.
667
668 @item @b{Scripts}
669 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
670 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
671 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
672
673 @item @b{Commands}
674 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
675 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
676 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
677 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
678
679 @item @b{Historical Note}
680 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
681 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
682 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
683 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
684
685 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
686 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
687 @end itemize
688
689 @node Running
690 @chapter Running
691 @cindex command line options
692 @cindex logfile
693 @cindex directory search
694
695 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
696 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
697 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
698 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
699 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
700 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
701 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
702
703 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
704 tell it how each debug session should work.
705 The @option{--help} option shows:
706 @verbatim
707 bash$ openocd --help
708
709 --help | -h display this help
710 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
711 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
712 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
713 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
714 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
715 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
716 --command | -c run <command>
717 @end verbatim
718
719 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
720 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
721 To specify one or more different
722 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
723
724 @example
725 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
726 @end example
727
728 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
729 @enumerate
730 @item the current directory,
731 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
732 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
733 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
734 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
735 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
736 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
737 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
738 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
739 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
740 @end enumerate
741 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
742
743 @quotation Note
744 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
745 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
746 @end quotation
747
748 @section Simple setup, no customization
749
750 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
751 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
752 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
753 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
754 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
755
756 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
757 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
758 the server with some variation of one of the following:
759
760 @example
761 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
762 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
763 @end example
764
765 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
766 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
767 If all goes well you'll see output something like
768
769 @example
770 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
771 For bug reports, read
772 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
773 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
774 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
775 @end example
776
777 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
778 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
779 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
780
781 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
782
783 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
784 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
785 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
786 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
787 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
788 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
789 ensure that this always succeeds.
790 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
791 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
792 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
793 and then shut down without acting as a server.
794
795 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
796 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
797 those channels.
798
799 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
800 the @option{-d} option.
801
802 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
803 @option{-c} command line switch.
804
805 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
806 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
807 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
808 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
809 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
810 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
811 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
812
813 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
814 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
815
816 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
817 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
818 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
819 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
820
821 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
822 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
823
824 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
825 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
826 and start the OpenOCD server.
827 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
828 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
829 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
830 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
831
832 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
833
834 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
835 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
836 and a USB cable on the other.
837 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
838 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
839
840 @enumerate
841 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
842 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
843 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
844 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
845 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
846 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
847 debugging host.
848
849 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
850 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
851 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
852 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
853 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
854
855 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
856 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
857 with 1.2 Volt boards.
858
859 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
860 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
861 ways to connect the cable.
862 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
863 Be sure it's firmly connected.
864
865 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
866 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
867 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
868 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
869 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
870 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
871 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
872 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
873
874 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
875 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
876 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
877 but are tedious to set up.
878 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
879 adapter signals to the right board pins.
880
881 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
882 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
883 you are using to run OpenOCD.
884 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
885
886 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
887 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
888 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
889 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
890
891 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
892 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
893 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
894
895 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
896 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
897 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
898 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
899
900 @end enumerate
901
902 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
903 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
904 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
905
906 @section Project Directory
907
908 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
909
910 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
911 single directory for your work with a given board.
912 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
913 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
914 files accessed through semihosting,
915 and for code you upload to the target board.
916 It is also the natural place to write files,
917 such as log files and data you download from the board.
918
919 @section Configuration Basics
920
921 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
922 a variety of ways you can mix them.
923 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
924
925 @itemize
926 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
927 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
928 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
929 @end itemize
930
931 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
932 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
933 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
934
935 @example
936 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
937
938 # GDB can also flash my flash!
939 gdb_memory_map enable
940 gdb_flash_program enable
941
942 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
943 @end example
944
945 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
946
947 @example
948 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
949 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
950 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
951 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
952 @end example
953
954 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
955 each supporting a different development task.
956 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
957 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
958
959 @quotation Important
960 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
961 problems with how it treats variables.
962 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
963 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
964 that can be tested in a later script.
965 @end quotation
966
967 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
968 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
969 to simplify your work.
970
971 @section User Config Files
972 @cindex config file, user
973 @cindex user config file
974 @cindex config file, overview
975
976 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
977 in one place.
978 One of the following will match your situation best:
979
980 @itemize
981 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
982 provided by someone else.
983 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
984 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
985 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
986 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
987 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
988 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
989
990 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
991 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
992
993 @enumerate
994 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
995 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
996 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
997 @end enumerate
998
999 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
1000 The first is an interface config file.
1001 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
1002 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
1003 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
1004 meet your deadline:
1005
1006 @example
1007 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1008 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1009 @end example
1010
1011 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1012 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1013 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1014 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1015
1016 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1017 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1018 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1019 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1020 target and board
1021 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1022 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1023
1024 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1025 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1026 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1027 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1028
1029 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1030 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1031 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1032 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1033 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1034
1035 @quotation Note
1036 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1037 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1038 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1039 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1040 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1041 @end quotation
1042
1043 @item
1044 You may need to write some C code.
1045 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1046 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1047 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1048 a new chip architecture.
1049 @end itemize
1050
1051 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1052 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1053 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1054
1055 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1056 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1057 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1058 @itemize
1059
1060 @item
1061 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1062 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1063 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1064 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1065
1066 @item
1067 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1068 @cindex vector_catch
1069 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1070 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1071 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1072 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1073 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1074 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1075
1076 @item
1077 You might need to override some defaults.
1078 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1079 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1080
1081 @item
1082 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1083 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1084 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1085 @end itemize
1086
1087 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1088
1089 A few project-specific utility
1090 routines may well speed up your work.
1091 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1092
1093 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1094 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1095 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1096 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1097 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1098 may help:
1099
1100 @example
1101 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1102 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1103 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1104 # Leave the CPU halted.
1105 reset init
1106
1107 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1108 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1109
1110 # Start running.
1111 resume 0x20000000
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1116 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1117 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1118 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1119 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1120
1121 @example
1122 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1123 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1124 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1125 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1126 reset init
1127
1128 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1129 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1130 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1131 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1132 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1133 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1134 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1135
1136 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1137 reset run
1138 @}
1139 @end example
1140
1141 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1142 from NAND.
1143 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1144 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1145 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1146
1147 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1148 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1149
1150 @section Target Software Changes
1151
1152 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1153 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1154 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1155 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1156 handling issues like:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159
1160 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1161 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1162 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1163 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1164 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1165 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1166 your debug sessions.
1167
1168 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1169 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1170 That might however be your only option.
1171
1172 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1173 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1174 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1175 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1176 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1177 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1178 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1179 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1180 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1181 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1182 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1183 instead of the whole thing.
1184 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1185 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1188 @cindex ARM semihosting
1189 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1190 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1191 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1192 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1193 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1194 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1195 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1196 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1197 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1198 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1199 NAND or SPI flash.
1200
1201 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1202 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1203 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1204 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1205 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1206
1207 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1208 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1209 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1210 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1211 registers which can be used to change various features including
1212 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1213 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1214 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1215 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1216 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1217
1218 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1219 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1220 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1221 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1222 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1223
1224 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1225 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1226 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1227 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1228 early code execution can be debugged
1229 or firmware can be replaced.
1230
1231 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1232 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1233 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1234 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1235 operations like writing to memory.)
1236
1237 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1238 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1239 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1240 various kinds of message.
1241 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1242
1243 @end itemize
1244
1245 @section Target Hardware Setup
1246
1247 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1248 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1249 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1250 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1251 working with.}
1252
1253 Common issues include:
1254
1255 @itemize @bullet
1256
1257 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1258 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1259 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1260 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1261 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1262 or one from a daughtercard).
1263 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1264 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1265
1266 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1267 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1268 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1269 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1270 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1271 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1272
1273 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1274 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1275 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1276 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1277 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1278
1279
1280 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1281 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1282 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1283 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1284 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1285 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1286 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1287
1288 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1289 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1290 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1291 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1292 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1293
1294 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1295 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1296 used to start booting.
1297
1298 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1299 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1300 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1301 multiple audio codec chips).
1302 This interacts with software
1303 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1304 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1305 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1306 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1307 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1308 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1309 audio or video codecs are used.
1310
1311 @end itemize
1312
1313 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1314 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1315 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1316 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1317 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1318 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1319 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1320 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1321 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1322 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1323
1324
1325 @node Config File Guidelines
1326 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1327
1328 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1329 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1330 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1331 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1332
1333 You should find the following directories under
1334 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1335 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1336 @itemize @bullet
1337 @item @file{interface} ...
1338 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1339 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1340 @item @file{board} ...
1341 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1342 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1343
1344 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1345 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1346 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1347 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1348 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1349 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1350 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1351 a CPU and an FPGA.
1352 @item @file{target} ...
1353 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1354 on a chip
1355 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1356 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1357 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1358 the target config file defines all of them.
1359 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1360 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1361 @end itemize
1362
1363 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1364 file may override features in any of the above files by
1365 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1366 commands specific to their situation.
1367
1368 @section Interface Config Files
1369
1370 The user config file
1371 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1372
1373 @example
1374 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1375 @end example
1376
1377 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1378 in use today with OpenOCD.
1379 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1380 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1381
1382 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1383 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1384 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1385 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1386 and need to provide a driver for it.
1387
1388 @section Board Config Files
1389 @cindex config file, board
1390 @cindex board config file
1391
1392 The user config file
1393 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1394
1395 @example
1396 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1397 @end example
1398
1399 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1400 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1401 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1402
1403 @enumerate
1404 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1405 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1406 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1407 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1408 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1409 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1410 @end enumerate
1411
1412 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1413 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1414 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1415 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1416
1417 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1418 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1419 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1420 configuration works.
1421
1422 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1423
1424 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1425 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1426 convention on how to use certain variables.
1427
1428 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1429 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1430 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1431 used at will within a target configuration file.
1432
1433 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1434 for a board with three chips:
1435
1436 @example
1437 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1438 set CHIPNAME network
1439 set ENDIAN big
1440 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1441 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1442 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1443 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1444
1445 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1446 set CHIPNAME video
1447 set ENDIAN little
1448 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1449 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1450 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1451 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1452
1453 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1454 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1455 unset ENDIAN
1456 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1457 @end example
1458
1459 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1460 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1461 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1462 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1463 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1464 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1465 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1466 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1467
1468 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1469 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1470 naming collisions.
1471
1472 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1473 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1474 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1475 up other clocks and peripherals.
1476
1477 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1478 @cindex variable names
1479
1480 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1481 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1482 one such chip (as shown above).
1483 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1484 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1485 to promote consistency and
1486 so that board files can override target defaults.
1487
1488 Inputs to target config files include:
1489
1490 @itemize @bullet
1491 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1492 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1493 tap identifier dotted names.
1494 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1495 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1496 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1497 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1498 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1499 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1500 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1501 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1502 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1503 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1504 @end itemize
1505
1506 Outputs from target config files include:
1507
1508 @itemize @bullet
1509 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1510 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1511 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1512 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1513 specific to that board and that target.
1514 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1515 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1516 @end itemize
1517
1518 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1519 @cindex event, reset-init
1520 @cindex reset-init handler
1521
1522 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1523 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1524 fully set up yet.
1525 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1526 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1527 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1528 handler is one of the most important.
1529
1530 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1531 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1532 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1533 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1534 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1535
1536 @quotation Note
1537 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1538 are included here.
1539 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1540 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1541 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1542 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1543 @end quotation
1544
1545 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1546 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1547 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1548 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1549 those as parameters.
1550 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1551 and disabling the watchdog.
1552 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1553 the next developer doing such work.
1554 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1555
1556 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1557 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1558 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1559 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1560
1561 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1562
1563 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1564 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1565 a low JTAG clock rate.
1566 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1567 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1568 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1569 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1570 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1571 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1572 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1573
1574 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1575 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1576 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1577 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1578 which might be less than that.
1579
1580 @quotation Warning
1581 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1582 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1583 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1584 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1585 @end quotation
1586
1587 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1588 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1589 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1590 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1591 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1592 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1593
1594 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1595 @subsection The init_board procedure
1596 @cindex init_board procedure
1597
1598 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1599 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1600 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1601 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1602 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1603 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1604 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1605 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1606 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1607 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1608 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1609 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1610
1611 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1612 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1613
1614 @example
1615 ### board_file.cfg ###
1616
1617 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1618 source [find target/target.cfg]
1619
1620 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1621 # enables fast on-board clock source
1622 # configures the chip to use it
1623 @}
1624
1625 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1626 proc init_board @{@} @{
1627 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1630 adapter speed 100
1631 @}
1632
1633 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1634 enable_fast_clock
1635 adapter speed 10000
1636 @}
1637 @}
1638 @end example
1639
1640 @section Target Config Files
1641 @cindex config file, target
1642 @cindex target config file
1643
1644 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1645 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1646 more target config files like this:
1647
1648 @example
1649 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1650 @end example
1651
1652 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1653 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1654 In summary the target files should contain
1655
1656 @enumerate
1657 @item Set defaults
1658 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1659 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1660 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1661 @item On-Chip flash
1662 @end enumerate
1663
1664 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1665 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1666 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1667
1668 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1669 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1670 can talk to the chip.
1671 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1672 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1673 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1674 and other processing engines.
1675
1676 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1677
1678 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1679 letting board config files express environment-specific
1680 differences in how things should be set up.
1681
1682 @example
1683 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1684 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1685 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1686 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1689 @}
1690
1691 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1692 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1693 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1694 @} else @{
1695 set _ENDIAN little
1696 @}
1697
1698 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1699 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1700 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1701 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1702 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1703 @} else @{
1704 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1705 @}
1706 @end example
1707 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1708
1709 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1710 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1711 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1712
1713 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1714 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1715 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1716
1717 @example
1718 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1719 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1720 @end example
1721
1722 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1723 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1724 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1725 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1726 for taps.
1727
1728 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1729 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1730 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1731 looks (in part) like this:
1732
1733 @example
1734 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1735 @end example
1736
1737 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1738 to source such a config file twice, with different
1739 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1740 it adds a different TAP each time.
1741
1742 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1743 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1744 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1745 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1746
1747 @example
1748 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1749 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1750 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1751 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1752 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1753 @end example
1754
1755 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1756 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1757
1758 @itemize
1759 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1760 plus a JRC to enable them
1761 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1762 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1763 is not currently used)
1764 @end itemize
1765
1766 @subsection Add CPU targets
1767
1768 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1769 GDB and other commands can use it.
1770 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1771 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1772 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1773 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1774
1775 @example
1776 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1777 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1778 @end example
1779
1780 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1781 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1782 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1783 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1784 a work area if you can.
1785 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1786
1787 @example
1788 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1789 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1790 @end example
1791
1792 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1793 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1794 @cindex SMP
1795 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1796
1797 @example
1798 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1800 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1801 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1802 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1803 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1804 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1805 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1806 @end example
1807 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1808 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1809 @itemize @bullet
1810 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1811 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1812 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1813 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1814 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1815 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1816 @end itemize
1817
1818 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1819 command have been implemented.
1820 @itemize @bullet
1821 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1822 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1823 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1824 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1825 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1826 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1827 following example.
1828 @end itemize
1829
1830 @example
1831 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1832 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1833 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1835 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1837 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1839 > resume
1840 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1841 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1842 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1843 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1847 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1848 @end example
1849
1850
1851 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1852
1853 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1854 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1855 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1856
1857 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1858 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1859 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1860 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1861 both signals.
1862
1863 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1864 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1865 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1866 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1867 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1868 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1869 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1870 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1871 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1872 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1873 not available.)
1874
1875 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1876 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1877 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1878 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1879 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1880 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1881 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1882 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1883
1884 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1885 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1886 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1887 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1888 slower clock than they will use later.
1889 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1890 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1891 than they will use later.
1892 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1893
1894 @quotation Important
1895 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1896 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1897 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1898 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1899 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1900 @end quotation
1901
1902 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1903 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1904 @cindex init_targets procedure
1905
1906 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1907 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1908 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1909 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1910 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1911 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1912 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1913 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1914 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1915
1916 @example
1917 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1918
1919 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1920 # basic initialization procedure ...
1921 @}
1922
1923 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1924 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1925 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1926 @}
1927
1928 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1929
1930 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1931
1932 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1933 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1934 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1935 @}
1936 @end example
1937
1938 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1939 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1940
1941 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1942
1943 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1944 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1945
1946 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1947 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1948 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1949
1950 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1951 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1952 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1953 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1954 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1955 events already assigned.
1956
1957 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1958
1959 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1960 special high speed download features - enable it.
1961
1962 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1963
1964 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1965 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1966 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1967 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1968 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1969 If you are using an external trace port,
1970 configure it in your board config file.
1971 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1972 configure it in your target config file.
1973
1974 @example
1975 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1976 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1977 @end example
1978
1979 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1980
1981 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1982
1983 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1984 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1985 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1986 the TARGET (chip) file.
1987
1988 Examples:
1989 @itemize @bullet
1990 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1991 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1992 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1993 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1994 @end itemize
1995
1996 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1997 @section Translating Configuration Files
1998 @cindex translation
1999 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2000 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2001 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2002 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2003 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2004 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2005
2006 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2007 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2008 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2009 convert other scripts later on.
2010
2011 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2012 replace job:
2013
2014 @example
2015 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2016 #
2017 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2018 #
2019 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2020 #
2021 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2022
2023 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2024 global TARGETNAME
2025
2026 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2027
2028 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2029 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2030 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2031 @}
2032 @end example
2033
2034
2035
2036 @node Server Configuration
2037 @chapter Server Configuration
2038 @cindex initialization
2039 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2040 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2041 supported.
2042
2043 @anchor{configurationstage}
2044 @section Configuration Stage
2045 @cindex configuration stage
2046 @cindex config command
2047
2048 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2049 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2050 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2051 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2052 inside startup scripts.
2053
2054 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2055 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2056 which may be issued interactively.
2057 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2058 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2059
2060 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2061 flash banks,
2062 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2063 and other basic setup.
2064 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2065 may access or activate TAPs.
2066 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2067 longer be issued.
2068
2069 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2070 @section Entering the Run Stage
2071
2072 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2073 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2074 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2076 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2077 You should see no errors at this point.
2078 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2079 commands you used to configure the server.
2080 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2081 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2082 on the scan chain.
2083
2084 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2085 become available.
2086 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2087 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2088 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2089 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2090 entry to the run stage.
2091
2092 @deffn {Config Command} init
2093 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2094 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2095 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2096 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2097 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2098 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2099
2100 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2101 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2102 configuration files and/or command line options.
2103
2104 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2105 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2106 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2107 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2108 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2112 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2113 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2114
2115 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2116 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2117 scan chain.
2118 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2119 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2120
2121 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2122 they return.
2123 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2124 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 @anchor{tcpipports}
2128 @section TCP/IP Ports
2129 @cindex TCP port
2130 @cindex server
2131 @cindex port
2132 @cindex security
2133 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2134 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2135 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2136
2137 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2138 access using one or more of these ports.
2139 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2140 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2141 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2142
2143 @anchor{gdb_port}
2144 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2145 @cindex GDB server
2146 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2147 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2148 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2149 the normal use cases.
2150
2151 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2152 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2153 disables the gdb server.
2154
2155 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2156 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2157
2158 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2159 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2160
2161 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2162 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2163 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2164
2165 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2166 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2167 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2168 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2169 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2170 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2171 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2172 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2173 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2174
2175 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2176 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2177 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2181 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2182 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2183 output from the Tcl engine.
2184 Intended as a machine interface.
2185 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2186 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2187 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2188 @end deffn
2189
2190 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2191 Specify or query the
2192 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2193 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2194 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2195 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2196 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2197 @end deffn
2198
2199 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2200 @section GDB Configuration
2201 @cindex GDB
2202 @cindex GDB configuration
2203 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2204 The ones listed here are static and global.
2205 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2206 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2207
2208 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2209 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2210 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2211 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2212 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2213 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2214 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2220 vFlash packet is received.
2221 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2226 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2227 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2228 for flash programming to work.
2229 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2230 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2231 @end deffn
2232
2233 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2234 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2235 by GDB memory read packets.
2236 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2237 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2238 @end deffn
2239
2240 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2241 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2242 packets report errors or not.
2243 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2244 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2245 @end deffn
2246
2247 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2248 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2249 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2250 @end deffn
2251
2252 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2253 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2254
2255 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2256 @end deffn
2257
2258 @anchor{eventpolling}
2259 @section Event Polling
2260
2261 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2262 where significant events can happen at any time.
2263 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2264 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2265 or to GDB.
2266
2267 Examples of such events include:
2268
2269 @itemize
2270 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2271 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2272 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2273 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2274 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2275 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2276 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2277 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2278 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2279 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2280 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2281 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2282 @end itemize
2283
2284 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2285 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2286 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2287 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2288 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2289
2290 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2291 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2292 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2293 to the various active targets.
2294 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2295 which is normally done in the background.
2296
2297 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2298 Poll the current target for its current state.
2299 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2300 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2301 specific information about the current state is printed.
2302 An optional parameter
2303 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2304
2305 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2306 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2307 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2308 @example
2309 > poll
2310 background polling: on
2311 target state: halted
2312 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2313 current mode: Supervisor
2314 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2315 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2316 >
2317 @end example
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2321 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2322 @cindex config file, interface
2323 @cindex interface config file
2324
2325 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2326 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2327 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2328
2329 @quotation Note
2330 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2331 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2332 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2333 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2334 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2335 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2336 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2337 @end quotation
2338
2339 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2340 through commands in an interface configuration
2341 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2342 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2343
2344 @example
2345 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2346 @end example
2347
2348 These commands tell
2349 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2350 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2351
2352 @example
2353 # jlink interface
2354 adapter driver jlink
2355 @end example
2356
2357 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2358
2359
2360 @section Adapter Configuration
2361
2362 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2363 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2364 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2365
2366 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2367 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2368 target.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2372 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2373 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2374 @end deffn
2375 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2376 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2377 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2378 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2379 the hardware can support.
2380 @end deffn
2381
2382
2383
2384 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2385 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2389 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2390 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2391 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2392 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2393 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2394 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2395
2396 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @section Interface Drivers
2400
2401 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2402 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2403 available at run time.
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2406 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2407 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2408 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2409
2410 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2411 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2412 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2416 Displays status of RTCK option.
2417 Optionally sets that option first.
2418 @end deffn
2419 @end deffn
2420
2421 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2422 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2423 This has one driver-specific command:
2424
2425 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2426 Logs some status
2427 @end deffn
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2431 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2432 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2433 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2434 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2435 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2436 @end deffn
2437
2438 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2439 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2440 or v2 (USB bulk).
2441
2442 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2443 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2444 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2445 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2446 @example
2447 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2448 @end example
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2452 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2453 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2457 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2458
2459 @itemize @minus
2460 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2461 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2462 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2463 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2464 @end itemize
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2468 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2469 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2470 interface string or for user class interface.
2471 @end deffn
2472
2473 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2474 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2475 @end deffn
2476 @end deffn
2477
2478 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2479 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2483 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2484 @end deffn
2485
2486 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2487 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2488 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2489
2490 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2491 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2492
2493 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2494 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2495
2496 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2497 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2498 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2499 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2500 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2501 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2502
2503 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2504 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2505 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2506 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2507 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2508
2509 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2510 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2511 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2512 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2513
2514 @itemize @minus
2515 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2516 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2517 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2518 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2519 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2520 switching data and direction as necessary
2521 @end itemize
2522
2523 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2524 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2525
2526 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2527 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2528 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2529 @example
2530 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2531 @end example
2532 @end deffn
2533
2534 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2535 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2536 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2537 during device selection.
2538 @end deffn
2539
2540 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2541 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2542 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2543 is connected to the host.
2544 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2545 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2546 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2550 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2551 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2552
2553 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2554 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2555 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2556 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2557 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2558
2559 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2563 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2564 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2568 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2569 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2570 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2571 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2572 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2573 and initially asserted reset signals.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2577 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2578 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2579 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2580 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2581 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2582 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2583 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2584 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2585 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2586 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2587
2588 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2589 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2590 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2591 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2592 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2593 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2594
2595 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2596 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2597 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2598 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2599 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2600 are always driven by the FTDI.
2601
2602 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2603 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2604 @var{name}.
2605 @end deffn
2606
2607 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2608 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2609 @itemize @minus
2610 @item @option{0}, drive low
2611 @item @option{1}, drive high
2612 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2613 @end itemize
2614 @end deffn
2615
2616 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2617 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2618 @end deffn
2619
2620 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2621 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2622
2623 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2624 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2625 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2626 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2627 @itemize @minus
2628 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2629 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2630 @end itemize
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2634 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2635
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2639 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2640 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2641 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2642
2643 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2644 @itemize @minus
2645 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2646 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2647 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2648 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2649 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2650 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2651 @end itemize
2652
2653 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2654 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2655 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2656 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2657 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2658 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2659 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2660 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2661
2662 FT232R
2663 @itemize @minus
2664 @item bit 7 - RI
2665 @item bit 6 - DCD
2666 @item bit 5 - DSR
2667 @item bit 4 - DTR
2668 @item bit 3 - CTS
2669 @item bit 2 - RTS
2670 @item bit 1 - RXD
2671 @item bit 0 - TXD
2672 @end itemize
2673
2674 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2675 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2676
2677 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2678 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2679 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2680 @end deffn
2681
2682 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2683 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2684 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2685 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2689 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2690 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2694 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2698 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2699 @end deffn
2700
2701 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2702 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2706 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2707 @end deffn
2708
2709 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2710 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2714 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2715 @end deffn
2716
2717 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2718 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2719 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2720 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2721 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2722 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2723 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2724 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2725 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2726 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2727 @end deffn
2728
2729 @end deffn
2730
2731 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2732 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2733 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2734 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2735
2736 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2737 processors which are being simulated.
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2740 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2741 sockets instead of TCP.
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2745 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2746 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2750 something like:
2751
2752 @example
2753 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2754 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2755 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2756 @end example
2757
2758 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2759 named mysocket:
2760
2761 @example
2762 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2763 remote_bitbang_port 0
2764 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2765 @end example
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2769 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2770 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2771 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2774 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2775 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2776 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2777 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2778 @end deffn
2779
2780 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2781 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2782 default values are used.
2783 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2784 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2785 @example
2786 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2787 @end example
2788 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2789 @example
2790 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2791 @end example
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2795 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2796 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2797 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2798 target board.
2799
2800 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2801 @example
2802 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2803 reset_config srst_only
2804 @end example
2805 @end deffn
2806
2807 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2808 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2809 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2810 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2811 @end deffn
2812
2813 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2814 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2815 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2816 @end deffn
2817
2818 @end deffn
2819
2820 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2821 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2822 This has one driver-specific command:
2823
2824 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2825 Display either the address of the I/O port
2826 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2827 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2828 This is a write-once setting.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @end deffn
2831
2832 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2833 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2834 transports.
2835
2836 @quotation Compatibility Note
2837 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2838 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2839 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2840 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2841 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2842 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2843 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2844 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2845 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2846 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2847 @end quotation
2848
2849 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2850 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2851 states.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2854 Display free device internal memory.
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2857 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2858 command version.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2861 Display the device configuration.
2862 @end deffn
2863 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2864 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2865 power state.
2866 @end deffn
2867 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2868 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2869 @end deffn
2870 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2871 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2872 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2873 IP configuration.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2876 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2877 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2880 Reset the current configuration.
2881 @end deffn
2882 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2883 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2886 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2887 pairs.
2888
2889 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2890 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2891 @example
2892 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2893 @end example
2894 @end deffn
2895 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2896 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2897 pairs.
2898
2899 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2900 @example
2901 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2902 77a90000
2903 @end example
2904 @end deffn
2905 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2906 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2907 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2908 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2909 the serial number instead, if possible.
2910
2911 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2912 @end deffn
2913 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2914 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2915 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2916
2917 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2918 @end deffn
2919 @end deffn
2920
2921 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2922 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2923 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2924 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2925 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2926 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2927 configuration script.
2928
2929 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2930 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2931 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2932 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2933 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2934
2935 Known limitations:
2936 @itemize @bullet
2937 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2938 and 2.7 MHz.
2939 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2940 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2941 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2942 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2943 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2944 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2945 communications with the target.
2946 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2947 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2948 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2949 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2950 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2951 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2952 @end itemize
2953
2954 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2955 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2956 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2957 @end deffn
2958
2959 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2960 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2961 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2965 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2966 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2967 target as a side-effect.
2968 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2972 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2973 version, and target voltage.
2974 @end deffn
2975 @end deffn
2976
2977 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2978 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2979 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2980 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2981 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2982
2983 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2984 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2985 This is a write-once setting.
2986 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2987
2988 @itemize @minus
2989 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2990 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2991 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2992 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2993 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2994 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2995 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2996 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2997 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2998 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2999 some versions of
3000 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3001 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3002 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3003 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3004 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3005 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3006 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3007 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3008 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3009 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3010 @end itemize
3011 @end deffn
3012
3013 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
3014 Display either the address of the I/O port
3015 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3016 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3017 This is a write-once setting.
3018
3019 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3020 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3021 you may encounter a problem.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3025 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3026 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3027 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3028 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3029 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3030
3031 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3032 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3033 @quotation Tip
3034 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3035 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3036 @example
3037 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3038 > adapter speed 500
3039 @end example
3040 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3041 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3042 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3043 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3044 large set of samples.
3045 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3046 @example
3047 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3048 @end example
3049 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3050 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3051
3052 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3053 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3054 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3055 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3056 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3057 be conservative.
3058 @end quotation
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3062 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3063 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3067 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3068
3069 @example
3070 adapter driver parport
3071 parport_port 0x278
3072 parport_cable wiggler
3073 @end example
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3077 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3078 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3079 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3080 @end deffn
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3084 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3088 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3089 @end deffn
3090
3091 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3092 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3093
3094 @quotation Note
3095 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3096 which are not currently documented here.
3097 @end quotation
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @anchor{hla_interface}
3101 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3102 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3103 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3104 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3105
3106 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3107 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3108 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3109 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3110 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3111 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3114 Currently Not Supported.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3118 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3119 @end deffn
3120
3121 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3122 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3126 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3130 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3131 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3132
3133 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3134 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3135 ST-LINK server software module}.
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3139 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3140 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3141 @end deffn
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3145 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3146 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3147 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3148 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3149
3150 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3151 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3152 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3153 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3154
3155 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3156 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3157
3158 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3159 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3160 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3161
3162 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3163 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3164 ST-LINK server software module}.
3165
3166 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3170 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3171 @end deffn
3172
3173 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3174 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3175 @end deffn
3176 @end deffn
3177
3178 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3179 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3183 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3187 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3188 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3189 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3190 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3191
3192 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3193 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3194 XDS110 found will be used.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3198 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3199 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3200 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3201 @end deffn
3202
3203 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3204 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3205 version).
3206 @end deffn
3207 @end deffn
3208
3209 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3210 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3211 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3212 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3213 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3214
3215 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3216
3217 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3218 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3219
3220 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3221 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3222
3223 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3224
3225 @end deffn
3226 @end deffn
3227
3228 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3229 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3230 @end deffn
3231
3232 @quotation Note
3233 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3234 which are not currently documented here.
3235 @end quotation
3236
3237 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3238 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3239 No arguments: print status.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3243 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3244 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3245
3246 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3247 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3248 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3249 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3250 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3251 configuration on exit.
3252
3253 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3254 pinout.
3255
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3259 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3260 of the one which is most popular.
3261
3262 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3263
3264 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3265 pinout.
3266
3267 @end deffn
3268
3269
3270 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3271 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3272 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3273
3274 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3275 @end deffn
3276
3277
3278 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3279 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3280 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3281
3282 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3283 @end deffn
3284
3285
3286 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3287 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3288 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3289
3290 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3291 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3292 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3293
3294 @itemize @minus
3295 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3296 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3297 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3298 @end itemize
3299 @end deffn
3300
3301 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3302 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3303 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3304 @end deffn
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307
3308 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3309 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3310 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3311 DPI server interface.
3312
3313 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3314 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3315 @end deffn
3316
3317 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3318 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3319 @end deffn
3320 @end deffn
3321
3322
3323 @section Transport Configuration
3324 @cindex Transport
3325 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3326 and the debug adapter you are using,
3327 several transports may be available to
3328 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3329 @deffn Command {transport list}
3330 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3331 version of OpenOCD.
3332 @end deffn
3333
3334 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3335 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3336
3337 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3338 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3339 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3340 adapter's driver).
3341
3342 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3343 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3344 supported by the debug adapter.
3345
3346 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3347 transport, if any.
3348 @end deffn
3349
3350 @subsection JTAG Transport
3351 @cindex JTAG
3352 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3353 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3354 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3355 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3356 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3357 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3358
3359 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3360 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3361 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3362 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3363 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3364
3365 @subsection SWD Transport
3366 @cindex SWD
3367 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3368 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3369 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3370 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3371 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3372 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3373 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3374
3375 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3376 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3377 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3378 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3379 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3380
3381 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3382 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3383 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3384 expected to change.
3385 @end deffn
3386 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3387 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3388 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3389 No parameters: displays current settings.
3390 @end deffn
3391
3392 @subsection SPI Transport
3393 @cindex SPI
3394 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3395 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3396 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3397 solution for flash programming.
3398
3399 @anchor{swimtransport}
3400 @subsection SWIM Transport
3401 @cindex SWIM
3402 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3403 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3404 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3405 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3406
3407 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3408
3409 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3410
3411 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3412 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3413 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3414 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3415 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3416
3417 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3418 @section JTAG Speed
3419 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3420 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3421 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3422 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3423 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3424 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3425 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3426 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3427 power management software that may be active.
3428
3429 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3430 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3431 target event handler.
3432 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3433 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3434 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3435 sets up those clocks).
3436 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3437 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3438 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3439 in the target config file.
3440 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3441 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3442 config file instead.
3443 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3444 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3445 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3446
3447 @example
3448 jtag_rclk 3000
3449 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3450 @end example
3451
3452 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3453 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3454 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3455 may not be the fastest solution.
3456
3457 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3458 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3459 which support adaptive clocking.
3460
3461 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3462 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3463 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3464 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3465 than the speed specified.
3466
3467 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3468 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3469 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3470 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3471
3472 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3473 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3474 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3475 JTAG clocking after setup.
3476 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3477 If the interface device can not
3478 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3479 @end deffn
3480
3481 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3482 @cindex adaptive clocking
3483 @cindex RTCK
3484 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3485 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3486 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3487 @example
3488 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3489 jtag_rclk 3000
3490 @end example
3491 @end defun
3492
3493 @node Reset Configuration
3494 @chapter Reset Configuration
3495 @cindex Reset Configuration
3496
3497 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3498 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3499 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3500 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3501 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3502 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3503 Please see the various board files for examples.
3504
3505 @quotation Note
3506 To maintainers and integrators:
3507 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3508 Normally the board configuration file
3509 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3510 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3511
3512 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3513 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3514 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3515 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3516 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3517 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3518 @end quotation
3519
3520 @section Types of Reset
3521
3522 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3523 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3524 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3525
3526 @itemize @bullet
3527 @item
3528 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3529 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3530 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3531 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3532 @item
3533 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3534 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3535 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3536 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3537 @item
3538 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3539 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3540 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3541 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3542 @item
3543 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3544 several other types of reset.
3545 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3546 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3547 There may be individual module resets.
3548 @end itemize
3549
3550 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3551 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3552 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3553 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3554 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3555 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3556 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3557 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3558 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3559
3560 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3561 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3562
3563 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3564 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3565 common issues are:
3566
3567 @itemize @bullet
3568
3569 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3570 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3571 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3572 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3573 when either of those signals is not connected.
3574 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3575 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3576 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3577 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3578
3579 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3580 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3581 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3582 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3583
3584 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3585 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3586 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3587 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3588 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3589 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3590 hardware debouncing.
3591 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3592 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3593
3594 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3595 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3596 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3597 to use push/pull output drivers.
3598 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3599 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3600 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3601 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3602
3603 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3604 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3605 issues (not limited to errata).
3606 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3607 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3608 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3609 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3610 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3611 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3612 @end itemize
3613
3614 There can also be other issues.
3615 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3616 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3617 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3618 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3619 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3620 Agreement (NDA).
3621
3622 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3623 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3624 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3625
3626 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3627 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3628
3629 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3630
3631 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3632 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3633 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3634 allowing it to be deasserted.
3635 @end deffn
3636
3637 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3638 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3639 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3640 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3641 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3642 @end deffn
3643
3644 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3645 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3646 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3647 allowing it to be deasserted.
3648 @end deffn
3649
3650 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3651 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3652 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3653 @end deffn
3654
3655 @anchor{reset_config}
3656 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3657 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3658 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3659 configuration scripts.
3660
3661 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3662 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3663 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3664 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3665 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3666 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3667 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3668 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3669
3670 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3671 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3672 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3673 -- may be specified at a time.
3674 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3675 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3676 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3677 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3678 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3679
3680 @itemize
3681 @item
3682 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3683 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3684 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3685 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3686 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3687
3688 @quotation Tip
3689 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3690 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3691 @end quotation
3692
3693 @item
3694 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3695 signal implementations.
3696 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3697 indicating everything behaves normally.
3698 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3699 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3700 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3701 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3702 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3703 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3704 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3705
3706 @item
3707 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3708 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3709 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3710 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3711 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3712 while SRST is asserted.
3713 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3714 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3715
3716 @item
3717 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3718 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3719 is required to use this option.
3720 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3721 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3722 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3723 be asserted before any target connection.
3724 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3725 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3726 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3727 @end itemize
3728
3729 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3730 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3731 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3732 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3733 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3734
3735 @itemize
3736 @item
3737 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3738 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3739 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3740 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3741
3742 @item
3743 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3744 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3745 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3746 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3747 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3748 @end itemize
3749 @end deffn
3750
3751 @section Custom Reset Handling
3752 @cindex events
3753
3754 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3755 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3756 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3757 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3758 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3759 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3760
3761 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3762 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3763 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3764 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3765 want to reset everything at once.
3766
3767 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3768 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3769 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3770 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3771 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3772 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3773 needs special attention.
3774
3775 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3776 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3777 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3778 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3779 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3780 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3781 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3782 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3783 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3784
3785 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3786 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3787 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3788 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3789 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3790
3791 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3792 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3793 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3794 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3795 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3796 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3797 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3798 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3799 or potentially some other value.
3800
3801 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3802 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3803 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3804 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3805 (or their associated targets)
3806 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3807
3808 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3809 they return.
3810 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3811 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3812 @end deffn
3813
3814 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3815 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3816 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3817 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3818 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3819 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3820 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3821 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3822 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3823 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3824 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3825 @end deffn
3826
3827 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3828 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3829 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3830 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3831 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3832 @end deffn
3833
3834
3835 @node TAP Declaration
3836 @chapter TAP Declaration
3837 @cindex TAP declaration
3838 @cindex TAP configuration
3839
3840 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3841 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3842
3843 @itemize @bullet
3844 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3845 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3846 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3847 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3848 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3849 start running that code.
3850 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3851 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3852 and missing connections.
3853 @end itemize
3854
3855 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3856 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3857 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3858 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3859 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3860
3861 @section Scan Chains
3862 @cindex scan chain
3863
3864 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3865 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3866 They also need to be added to
3867 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3868 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3869 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3870 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3871 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3872 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3873 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3874 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3875
3876 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3877 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3878 command, presented in the next chapter.
3879 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3880 debugging targets.)
3881 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3882
3883 @verbatim
3884 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3885 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3886 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3887 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3888 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3889 @end verbatim
3890
3891 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3892 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3893 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3894 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3895 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3896 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3897 until they are told to do so.
3898
3899 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3900 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3901 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3902 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3903
3904 @example
3905 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3906 @end example
3907
3908 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3909 by a given chip.
3910 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3911 and so forth.
3912 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3913 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3914 both inside a single chip and between them.
3915 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3916
3917 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3918 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3919 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3920 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3921 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3922 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3923 includes commands something like this:
3924
3925 @example
3926 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3927 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3928 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3929 @end example
3930
3931 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3932 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3933 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3934
3935 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3936 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3937 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3938 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3939 @example
3940 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3941 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3942 @}
3943 @end example
3944 @end deffn
3945
3946 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3947 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3948 and their status.
3949 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3950 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3951 but systems with a JTAG router can
3952 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3953 @end deffn
3954
3955 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3956 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3957
3958 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3959 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3960
3961 @section TAP Names
3962 @cindex dotted name
3963
3964 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3965 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3966 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3967 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3968 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3969 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3970 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3971 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3972
3973 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3974 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3975 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3976
3977 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3978
3979 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3980 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3981 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3982 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3983
3984 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3985 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3986 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3987 overridable.
3988
3989 @cindex TAP naming convention
3990 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3991 and should follow this convention:
3992
3993 @itemize @bullet
3994 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3995 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3996 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3997 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3998 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3999 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4000 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4001 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4002 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4003 with a single TAP;
4004 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4005 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4006 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4007 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4008 @end itemize
4009
4010 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4011
4012 @itemize @bullet
4013 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4014 @*The length in bits of the
4015 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4016 @end itemize
4017
4018 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4019
4020 @itemize @bullet
4021 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4022 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4023 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4024 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4025 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4026 (the TAP is linked in).
4027 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4028 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4029 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4030 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4031 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4032 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4033 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4034 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4035 values that were found but not included in the list.
4036
4037 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4038 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4039 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4040 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4041 hardware to find these values.
4042 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4043 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4044 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4045 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4046 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4047 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4048 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4049 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4050 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4051 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4052 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4053 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4054 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4055 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4056 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4057 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4058 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4059 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4060 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4061 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4062 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4063 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4064 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4065 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4066 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4067 @end itemize
4068 @end deffn
4069
4070 @section Other TAP commands
4071
4072 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4073 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4074 @end deffn
4075
4076 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4077 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4078 At this writing this TAP attribute
4079 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4080 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4081 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4082 See the next section for information about the available events.
4083
4084 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4085 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4086 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4087 @end deffn
4088
4089 @section TAP Events
4090 @cindex events
4091 @cindex TAP events
4092
4093 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4094 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4095 The other applies to debugger targets,
4096 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4097
4098 The TAP events currently defined are:
4099
4100 @itemize @bullet
4101 @item @b{post-reset}
4102 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4103 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4104 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4105 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4106 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4107
4108 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4109 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4110 of any particular target.
4111 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4112 @item @b{setup}
4113 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4114 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4115 @item @b{tap-disable}
4116 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4117 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4118 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4119 @item @b{tap-enable}
4120 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4121 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4122 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4123 @end itemize
4124
4125 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4126 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4127 contents to be accurate), you might:
4128
4129 @example
4130 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4131 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4132 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4133 @}
4134 @end example
4135
4136
4137 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4138 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4139 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4140 @cindex jrc
4141
4142 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4143 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4144 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4145 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4146 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4147
4148 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4149 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4150 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4151 be visible.
4152 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4153 ignores, such as:
4154
4155 @itemize
4156 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4157 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4158 TAPs receive new instructions.
4159 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4160 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4161 @end itemize
4162
4163 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4164 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4165 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4166 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4167
4168 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4169 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4170
4171 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4172 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4173 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4174 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4175 should define TAP event handlers using
4176 code that looks something like this:
4177
4178 @example
4179 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4180 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4181 @}
4182 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4183 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4184 @}
4185 @end example
4186
4187 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4188
4189 @example
4190 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4191 @end example
4192
4193 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4194 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4195 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4196 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4197
4198 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4199 If necessary, disables the tap
4200 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4201 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4202 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4203 and "0" if it is disabled.
4204 @end deffn
4205
4206 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4207 If necessary, enables the tap
4208 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4209 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4210 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4211 and "0" if it is disabled.
4212 @end deffn
4213
4214 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4215 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4216 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4217 and "0" if it is disabled.
4218
4219 @quotation Note
4220 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4221 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4222 @end quotation
4223 @end deffn
4224
4225 @anchor{autoprobing}
4226 @section Autoprobing
4227 @cindex autoprobe
4228 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4229
4230 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4231 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4232 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4233 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4234
4235 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4236 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4237 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4238 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4239 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4240 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4241 right when they come out of reset).
4242
4243 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4244
4245 @example
4246 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4247 reset_config trst_and_srst
4248 jtag_rclk 8
4249 @end example
4250
4251 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4252 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4253
4254 @enumerate
4255 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4256 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4257 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4258 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4259 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4260 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4261 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4262 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4263 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4264 that is discovered.
4265 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4266 register, it will report it.
4267 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4268 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4269 @end enumerate
4270
4271 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4272 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4273 that's a bit more complex:
4274
4275 @example
4276 clock speed 8 kHz
4277 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4278 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4279 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4280 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4281 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4282 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4283 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4284 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4285 @end example
4286
4287 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4288 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4289 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4290 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4291 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4292 and so forth.
4293
4294 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4295 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4296 @cindex DAP declaration
4297
4298 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4299 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4300 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4301 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4302 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4303
4304 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4305
4306 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4307 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4308 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4309 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4310 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4311
4312 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4313
4314 @itemize @bullet
4315 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4316 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4317 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4318 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4319 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4320 @end itemize
4321 @end deffn
4322
4323 @deffn Command {dap names}
4324 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4325 for TCL scripting.
4326 @end deffn
4327
4328 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4329 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4330 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4331 @end deffn
4332
4333 @deffn Command {dap init}
4334 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4335 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4336 initialization, too.
4337 @end deffn
4338
4339 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4340
4341 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4342 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4343 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4344 @end deffn
4345
4346 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4347 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4348 @end deffn
4349
4350 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4351 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4352 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4353 or set a new value @var{value}.
4354 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4355 @end deffn
4356
4357 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4358 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4359 @end deffn
4360
4361 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4362 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4363 value @var{value}.
4364
4365 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4366 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4367 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4368
4369 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4370 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4371 @end deffn
4372
4373 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4374 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4375 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4376 @end deffn
4377
4378 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4379 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4380 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4381 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4382 @end deffn
4383
4384 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4385 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4386
4387 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4388 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4389 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4390 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4391 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4392 for details.
4393
4394 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4395 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4396 the pattern:
4397 @example
4398 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4399 @end example
4400
4401 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4402 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4403 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4404 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4405 @example
4406 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4407 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4408 @end example
4409
4410 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4411 @example
4412 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4413 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4414 @end example
4415
4416 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4417 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4418
4419 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4420 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4421 example with a proper dap name:
4422 @example
4423 xxx.dap apcsw default
4424 @end example
4425 @end deffn
4426
4427 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4428 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4429 Disabled by default
4430 @end deffn
4431
4432
4433 @node CPU Configuration
4434 @chapter CPU Configuration
4435 @cindex GDB target
4436
4437 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4438 You can also access these targets without GDB
4439 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4440 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4441 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4442 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4443
4444 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4445 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4446
4447 @section Target List
4448 @cindex target, current
4449 @cindex target, list
4450
4451 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4452 where each member has a name.
4453 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4454 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4455 (plural!) command.
4456 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4457 look like with more than one:
4458 @verbatim
4459 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4460 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4461 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4462 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4463 @end verbatim
4464
4465 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4466 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4467 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4468 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4469 space seen by that current target.
4470 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4471 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4472 are examples; and there are many more.
4473
4474 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4475
4476 @deffn Command {target current}
4477 Returns the name of the current target.
4478 @end deffn
4479
4480 @deffn Command {target names}
4481 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4482 @example
4483 foreach t [target names] @{
4484 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4485 @}
4486 @end example
4487 @end deffn
4488
4489 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4490 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4491
4492 @deffn Command targets [name]
4493 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4494 command names are singular.}
4495
4496 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4497 targets in a user friendly form.
4498
4499 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4500 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4501 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4502 @end deffn
4503
4504 @section Target CPU Types
4505 @cindex target type
4506 @cindex CPU type
4507
4508 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4509 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4510 when calling @command{target create}.
4511 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4512 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4513 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4514 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4515 what core-specific commands may be available
4516 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4517 and more.
4518
4519 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4520 since there's a command to list them.
4521
4522 @anchor{targettypes}
4523 @deffn Command {target types}
4524 Lists all supported target types.
4525 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4526
4527 @itemize @bullet
4528 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4529 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4530 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4531 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4532 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4533 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4534 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4535 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4536 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4537 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4538 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4539 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4540 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4541 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4542 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4543 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4544 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4545 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4546 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4547 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4548 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4549 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4550 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4551 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4552 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4553 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4554 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4555 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4556 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4557 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4558 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4559 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4560 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4561 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4562 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4563 @itemize @minus
4564 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4565 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4566 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4567 @end itemize
4568 And two debug interfaces cores:
4569 @itemize @minus
4570 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4571 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4572 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4573 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4574 @end itemize
4575 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4576 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4577 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4578 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4579 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4580 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4581 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4582 @end itemize
4583 @end deffn
4584
4585 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4586 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4587 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4588 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4589 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4590 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4591 reflect design generations;
4592 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4593 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4594
4595 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4596 @section Target Configuration
4597
4598 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4599 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4600 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4601 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4602 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4603
4604 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4605 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4606 optional parts.
4607 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4608 command, created as part of target creation.
4609
4610 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4611 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4612 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4613 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4614 to be much more board-specific.
4615 The key steps you use might look something like this
4616
4617 @example
4618 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4619 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4620 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4621 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4622 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4623 @end example
4624
4625 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4626 on-chip SRAM.
4627 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4628 writes to target memory;
4629 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4630 GDB memory checksumming;
4631 and more.
4632
4633 @quotation Warning
4634 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4635 inaccessible when application code
4636 (such as an operating system)
4637 enables or disables the MMU.
4638 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4639 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4640 easy access to other addresses needed.
4641 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4642 @end quotation
4643
4644 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4645 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4646 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4647 controllers.
4648 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4649 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4650 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4651
4652 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4653 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4654 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4655 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4656 purposes including additional configuration.
4657
4658 @itemize @bullet
4659 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4660 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4661 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4662 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4663
4664 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4665 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4666 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4667 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4668 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4669 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4670 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4671
4672 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4673 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4674 @end itemize
4675 @end deffn
4676
4677 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4678 The options accepted by this command may also be
4679 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4680 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4681 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4682
4683 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4684 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4685 and changing its endianness.
4686
4687 @itemize @bullet
4688
4689 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4690 used to access this target.
4691
4692 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4693 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4694 create and manage DAP instances.
4695
4696 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4697 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4698
4699 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4700 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4701 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4702 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4703 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4704 same event name assigns only one handler.
4705
4706 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4707 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4708
4709 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4710 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4711 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4712 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4713 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4714 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4715 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4716
4717 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4718 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4719 or virtual address is being used.
4720
4721 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4722 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4723
4724 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4725 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4726 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4727 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4728 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4729
4730 @anchor{rtostype}
4731 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4732 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4733 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4734 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4735 @option{RIOT}
4736 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4737
4738 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4739 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4740 access the target for debugging.
4741
4742 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4743 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4744 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4745 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4746
4747 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4748 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4749 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4750 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4751 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4752
4753 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4754 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4755 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4756 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4757 command @command{gdb_port}.
4758 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4759
4760 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4761 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4762 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4763 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4764 @end itemize
4765 @end deffn
4766
4767 @section Other $target_name Commands
4768 @cindex object command
4769
4770 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4771 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4772
4773 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4774 Once a button is created a button
4775 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4776 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4777 configure it like this:
4778
4779 @example
4780 # Create
4781 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4782 # Modify
4783 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4784 # Query
4785 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4786 # Report
4787 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4788 @end example
4789
4790 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4791 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4792
4793 @example
4794 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4795 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4796 @end example
4797
4798 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4799
4800 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4801 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4802 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4803 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4804 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4805 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4806 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4807 They are not otherwise documented here.
4808 @end deffn
4809
4810 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4811 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4812 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4813 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4814 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4815 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4816 the target side uses raw memory.
4817
4818 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4819 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4820 The script orientation comes from working with data
4821 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4822 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4823 and neither store nor return those values.
4824
4825 @itemize
4826 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4827 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4828 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4829 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4830 @end itemize
4831 @end deffn
4832
4833 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4834 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4835 @command{$target_name configure}
4836 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4837 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4838 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4839 There are a few special cases:
4840
4841 @itemize @bullet
4842 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4843 event named @var{event_name}.
4844 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4845 two parameters.
4846 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4847 This is a special case because this is set using
4848 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4849 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4850 @end itemize
4851
4852 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4853 all the targets you might use something like this:
4854
4855 @example
4856 foreach name [target names] @{
4857 set y [$name cget -endian]
4858 set z [$name cget -type]
4859 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4860 $x $name $y $z]
4861 @}
4862 @end example
4863 @end deffn
4864
4865 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4866 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4867 Displays the current target state:
4868 @code{debug-running},
4869 @code{halted},
4870 @code{reset},
4871 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4872 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4873 @end deffn
4874
4875 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4876 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4877 currently associated with this target.
4878 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4879 @end deffn
4880
4881 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4882 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4883 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4884 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4885 @end deffn
4886
4887 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4888 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4889 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4890 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4891 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4892 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4893 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4894 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4895 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4896 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4897 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4898 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4899 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4900 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4901 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4902 @end deffn
4903
4904 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4905 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4906 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4907 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4908 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4909 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4910 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4911 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4912 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4913 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4914 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4915 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4916 @end deffn
4917
4918 @anchor{targetevents}
4919 @section Target Events
4920 @cindex target events
4921 @cindex events
4922 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4923 For example:
4924 @itemize @bullet
4925 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4926 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4927 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4928 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4929 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4930 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4931 to set up system clocks or
4932 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4933 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4934 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4935 @end itemize
4936
4937 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4938 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4939 @command{target create ... -event}.
4940
4941 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4942 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4943 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4944
4945 @example
4946 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4947 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4948 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4949 @}
4950 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4951 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4952 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4953 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4954 @}
4955 @end example
4956
4957 The following target events are defined:
4958
4959 @itemize @bullet
4960 @item @b{debug-halted}
4961 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4962 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4963 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4964 @item @b{early-halted}
4965 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4966 @item @b{examine-start}
4967 @* Before target examine is called.
4968 @item @b{examine-end}
4969 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4970 @item @b{examine-fail}
4971 @* After target examine fails.
4972 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4973 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4974 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4975 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4976 connect GDB to running target.
4977 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4978 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4979 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4980 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4981 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4982 is in RAM or read only memory.
4983 Default is @code{halt}
4984 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4985 @* When GDB disconnects
4986 @item @b{gdb-end}
4987 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4988 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4989 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4990 @code{reset init})
4991 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4992 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4993 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4994 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4995 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4996 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4997 @item @b{gdb-start}
4998 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4999 @item @b{halted}
5000 @* The target has halted
5001 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5002 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5003 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5004 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5005 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5006 @item @b{reset-assert}
5007 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5008 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5009 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5010 it instead of asserting SRST.
5011 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5012 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5013 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5014 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5015 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5016 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5017 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5018 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5019 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5020 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5021 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5022 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5023 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5024 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5025 released on the scan chain.
5026 @item @b{reset-end}
5027 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5028 @item @b{reset-init}
5029 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5030 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5031
5032 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5033 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5034 multiplexing, and so on.
5035 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5036 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5037 @item @b{reset-start}
5038 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5039 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5040
5041 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5042 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5043 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5044 @item @b{resume-start}
5045 @* Before any target is resumed
5046 @item @b{resume-end}
5047 @* After all targets have resumed
5048 @item @b{resumed}
5049 @* Target has resumed
5050 @item @b{step-start}
5051 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5052 @item @b{step-end}
5053 @* After single-step has completed
5054 @item @b{trace-config}
5055 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5056 @end itemize
5057
5058 @quotation Note
5059 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5060 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5061 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5062 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5063 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5064 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5065 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5066 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5067 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5068 check if the core has changed status.
5069 @end quotation
5070
5071 @node Flash Commands
5072 @chapter Flash Commands
5073
5074 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5075 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5076 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5077 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5078 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5079 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5080 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5081 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5082 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5083
5084 Flash Steps:
5085 @enumerate
5086 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5087 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5088 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5089 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5090 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5091 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5092 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5093 @item GDB Flashing
5094 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5095 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5096 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5097 @end enumerate
5098
5099 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5100 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5101 so that it can't boot.
5102 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5103 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5104
5105 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5106 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5107 @cindex flash configuration
5108
5109 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5110 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5111 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5112 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5113 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5114 see the driver-specific documentation.
5115
5116 @itemize @bullet
5117 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5118 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5119 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5120 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5121 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5122 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5123 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5124 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5125 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5126 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5127 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5128 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5129 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5130 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5131 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5132 commands to the flash controller.
5133 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5134 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5135 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5136 for more information.
5137 @end itemize
5138 @quotation Note
5139 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5140 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5141 @end quotation
5142 @end deffn
5143
5144 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5145 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5146 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5147 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5148 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5149 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5150 @end deffn
5151
5152 @deffn Command {flash list}
5153 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5154 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5155 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5156 @end deffn
5157
5158 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5159 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5160 depends on the flash type.
5161 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5162 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5163 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5164 but most don't bother.
5165 @end deffn
5166
5167 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5168
5169 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5170 begins.
5171
5172 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5173 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5174 until the programming session is finished.
5175
5176 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5177 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5178
5179 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5180
5181 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5182 @cindex flash erasing
5183 @cindex flash reading
5184 @cindex flash writing
5185 @cindex flash programming
5186 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5187
5188 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5189 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5190 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5191 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5192 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5193
5194 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5195 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5196 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5197 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5198 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5199
5200 @quotation Note
5201 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5202 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5203 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5204 back to a flash bank.
5205 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5206 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5207 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5208 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5209 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5210 @end quotation
5211
5212 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5213 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5214 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5215 disabled first.
5216 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5217 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5218 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5219
5220 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5221 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5222 up to and including @var{last}.
5223 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5224 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5225 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5226 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5230 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5231 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5232 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5233 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5234 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5235 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5236 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5237 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5238 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5239 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5240 before erase starts.
5241 @end deffn
5242
5243 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5244 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5245 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5246 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5247 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5248 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5249 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5250 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5251 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5252 before issuing this command.
5253 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5254 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5255 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5256 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5257 @end deffn
5258 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5259
5260 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5261 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5262 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5263 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5264 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5265 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5266 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5267 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5268 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5269 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5270 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5271 @end deffn
5272
5273 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5274 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5275 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5276 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5277 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5278 @end deffn
5279
5280 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5281 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5282 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5283 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5284 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5285 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5289 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5290 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5291 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5292 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5296 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5297 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5298 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5299 to the base address for each section in the image.
5300 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5301 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5302 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5303 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5304 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5305 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5306 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5307 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5308 each image section.
5309
5310 @quotation Warning
5311 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5312 data you want to preserve.
5313 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5314 sections might be erased with no notice.
5315 @itemize
5316 @item
5317 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5318 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5319 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5320 @item
5321 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5322 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5323 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5324 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5325 @end itemize
5326 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5327 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5328 @end quotation
5329
5330 @end deffn
5331
5332 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5333 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5334 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5335 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5336 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5337 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5338 ordinary memory reads.
5339 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5340 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5341 check for successful programming.
5342 @end deffn
5343
5344 @section Other Flash commands
5345 @cindex flash protection
5346
5347 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5348 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5349 and display that status.
5350 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5351 @end deffn
5352
5353 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5354 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5355 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5356
5357 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5358 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5359 and possibly stale information.
5360 @end deffn
5361
5362 @anchor{flashprotect}
5363 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5364 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5365 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5366 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5367 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5368 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5369 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5370 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5371 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5372 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5373 @end deffn
5374
5375 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5376 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5377 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5378 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5379 @end deffn
5380
5381 @anchor{program}
5382 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5383 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5384 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5385 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5389 @section Flash Driver List
5390 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5391 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5392 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5393
5394 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5395 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5396 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5397
5398 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5399
5400 @itemize
5401 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5402 @end itemize
5403
5404 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5405 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5406 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5407 @example
5408 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5409 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5410 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5411 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5412 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5413 @end example
5414 @end deffn
5415
5416 @subsection External Flash
5417
5418 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5419 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5420 @cindex CFI
5421 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5422 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5423 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5424 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5425 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5426 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5427 configure a bus and its timings), or
5428 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5429 on the flash chip.
5430 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5431 speed up operation.
5432
5433 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5434
5435 @itemize
5436 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5437 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5438 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5439 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5440 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5441 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5442 @end itemize
5443
5444 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5445 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5446
5447 @example
5448 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5450 @end example
5451
5452 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5453 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5454 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5455
5456 @example
5457 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5458 @end example
5459
5460 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5461 @end deffn
5462
5463 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5464 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5465 @cindex SPI
5466 @cindex jtagspi
5467 @cindex bscan_spi
5468 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5469 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5470 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5471 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5472 accessed through JTAG.
5473
5474 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5475 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5476 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5477 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5478 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5479 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5480
5481 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5482 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5483 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5484 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5485 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5486 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5487 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5488 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5489
5490 @itemize
5491 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5492 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5493 @var{USER1} instruction.
5494 @end itemize
5495
5496 @example
5497 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5498 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5499 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5500 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5501 @end example
5502 @end deffn
5503
5504 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5505 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5506 @cindex xcf
5507 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5508 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5509 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5510 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5511 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5512
5513 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5514 command accepts additional parameters:
5515 @itemize
5516 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5517 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5518 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5519 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5520 in master mode.
5521 @end itemize
5522 @example
5523 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5524 @end example
5525 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5526 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5527 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5528 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5529 dedicated sector.
5530 @end deffn
5531
5532 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5533 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5534 button.
5535 @example
5536 xcf configure 0
5537 @end example
5538 @end deffn
5539
5540 Additional driver notes:
5541 @itemize
5542 @item Only single revision supported.
5543 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5544 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5545 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5546 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5547 @end itemize
5548 @end deffn
5549
5550 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5551 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5552 @cindex SPIFI
5553 @cindex lpcspifi
5554 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5555 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5556 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5557
5558 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5559 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5560 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5561 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5562 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5563
5564 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5565 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5566 are configured by the driver.
5567
5568 @example
5569 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5570 @end example
5571
5572 @end deffn
5573
5574 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5575 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5576 @cindex SMI
5577 @cindex stmsmi
5578 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5579 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5580 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5581 SPI flash devices.
5582 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5583 flash devices can be connected.
5584
5585 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5586 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5587 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5588 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5589 the flash content.
5590
5591 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5592 to identify the memory bank.
5593 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5594 flash size, are detected automatically.
5595
5596 @example
5597 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5598 @end example
5599
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5603 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5604 @cindex QuadSPI
5605 @cindex OctoSPI
5606 @cindex stmqspi
5607 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5608 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5609 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5610 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5611 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5612 mode is not.
5613
5614 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5615 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5616 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5617 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5618
5619 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5620 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5621 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5622
5623 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5624 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5625 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5626 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5627 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5628 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5629
5630 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5631 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5632 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5633 should be avoided.
5634
5635 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5636 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5637 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5638 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5639 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5640 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5641
5642 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5643 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5644 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5645 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5646 persist across openocd invocations.
5647
5648 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5649 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5650 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5651 required (see 'set' command).
5652
5653 @example
5654 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5655 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5656 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5657 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5658 @end example
5659
5660 There are three specific commands
5661 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5662 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5663 chip specific write protection engaged.
5664 @end deffn
5665
5666 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5667 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5668 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5669 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5670 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5671 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5672
5673 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5674 which don't support an id command.
5675
5676 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5677 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5678 @end deffn
5679
5680 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5681 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5682 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5683 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5684 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5685
5686 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5687 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5688 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5689 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5690
5691 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5692
5693 To check basic communication settings, issue
5694 @example
5695 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5696 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5697 @end example
5698 for single flash mode or
5699 @example
5700 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5701 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5702 @end example
5703 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5704
5705 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5706 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5707 need a dummy address, e.g.
5708 @example
5709 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5710 @end example
5711 should return the status register contents.
5712
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @end deffn
5716
5717 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5718 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5719 Microcontroller platform.
5720
5721 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5722 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5723
5724 @example
5725 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5726 @end example
5727
5728 @end deffn
5729
5730 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5731 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5732 @cindex ath79
5733 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5734 chip selects.
5735 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5736 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5737 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5738 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5739 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5740 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5741
5742 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5743 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5744 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5745 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5746 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5747 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5748 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5749 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5750 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5751 with the default CS0.
5752 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5753 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5754 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5755
5756 @example
5757 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5758
5759 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5760 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5761 # distinguish the banks.
5762 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5763 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5764 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5765 @end example
5766
5767 @end deffn
5768
5769 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5770 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5771 @cindex fespi
5772
5773 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5774
5775 @example
5776 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5777 @end example
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5781
5782 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5783 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5784 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5785 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5786 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5787 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5788
5789 @example
5790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5791 @end example
5792 @end deffn
5793
5794 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5795 @cindex ambiqmicro
5796 @cindex apollo
5797 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5798 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5799 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5800 with the target using SWD.
5801
5802 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5803 the device class of the MCU.
5804 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5805 to set up the flash banks.
5806 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5807 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5808
5809 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5810 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5811 and the second bank starts after the first.
5812
5813 @example
5814 # Flash bank 0
5815 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5816 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5817 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5818 $_TARGETNAME
5819 @end example
5820
5821 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5822 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5823 are available to the user.
5824
5825 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5826
5827 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5828 Erase entire bank.
5829 @end deffn
5830 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5831 Erase device pages.
5832 @end deffn
5833 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5834 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5835 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5836 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5837 the flash.
5838 @end deffn
5839 @end deffn
5840
5841 @anchor{at91samd}
5842 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5843 @cindex at91samd
5844 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5845 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5846
5847 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5848
5849 The devices have one flash bank:
5850
5851 @example
5852 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5853 @end example
5854
5855 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5856 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5857 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5858 processor to be halted.
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5862 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5863 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5864 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5865 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5866 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5867
5868 @example
5869 at91samd set-security enable
5870 @end example
5871 @end deffn
5872
5873 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5874 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5875 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5876 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5877 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5878 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5879 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5880 in order to disable this feature.
5881
5882 @example
5883 at91samd eeprom
5884 at91samd eeprom 1024
5885 @end example
5886 @end deffn
5887
5888 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5889 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5890 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5891 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5892 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5893 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5894
5895 @example
5896 at91samd bootloader
5897 at91samd bootloader 16384
5898 @end example
5899 @end deffn
5900
5901 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5902 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5903 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5904 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5908 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5909 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5910 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5911 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5912 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5913 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5914 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5915
5916 @example
5917 # Read user row
5918 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5919 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5920 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5921 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5922 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5923 # byte unchanged
5924 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5925 @end example
5926 @end deffn
5927
5928 @end deffn
5929
5930 @anchor{at91sam3}
5931 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5932 @cindex at91sam3
5933 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5934 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5935 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5936 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5937 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5938 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5939 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5940 chips are confirmed.}
5941
5942 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5943 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5944 the following fixed locations:
5945
5946 @example
5947 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5948 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5949 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5950 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5951 @end example
5952
5953 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5954 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5955 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5956
5957 @itemize
5958 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5959 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5960 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5961 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5962 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5963 @end itemize
5964
5965 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5966
5967 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5968 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5969 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5970 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5971 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5972 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5973 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5974
5975 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5976 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5980 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5981 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5982 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5983 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5984 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5985 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5986 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5987 @end deffn
5988
5989 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5990 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5991 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5992 @end deffn
5993 @end deffn
5994
5995 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5996 @cindex at91sam4
5997 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5998 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5999 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6000 @end deffn
6001
6002 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
6003 @cindex at91sam4l
6004 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6005 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6006 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6007
6008 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6009 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6010 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6011 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6012 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6013 @end deffn
6014 @end deffn
6015
6016 @anchor{atsame5}
6017 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
6018 @cindex atsame5
6019 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6020 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6021 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6022
6023 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6024 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6025 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6026
6027 @example
6028 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6029 @end example
6030
6031 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
6032 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6033 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6034 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6035 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6036 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6037
6038 @example
6039 atsame5 bootloader
6040 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6041 @end example
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
6045 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6046 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6047 processor to be halted.
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6051 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6052 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6053 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6054 @end deffn
6055
6056 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
6057 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6058 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6059 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6060 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6061 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6062 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6063 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6064
6065 @example
6066 # Read
6067 >atsame5 userpage
6068 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6069 # Write
6070 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6071 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6072 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6073 # bytes)
6074 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6075 @end example
6076 @end deffn
6077
6078 @end deffn
6079
6080 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6081 @cindex atsamv
6082 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6083 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6084 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6085 @end deffn
6086
6087 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6088 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6089 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6090 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6091 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6092
6093 @example
6094 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6095 @end example
6096
6097 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6098 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6099
6100 @itemize
6101 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6102 @item @var{banks}
6103 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6104 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6105 @item @var{pages_size}
6106 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6107 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6108 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6109 @end itemize
6110
6111 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6112 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6113 will be autoconfigured.
6114 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6115
6116 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6117 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6118 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6119 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6120 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6121
6122 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6123 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6124 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6125 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6126 are not truly general purpose).
6127 @quotation Note
6128 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6129 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6130 @end quotation
6131 @end deffn
6132 @end deffn
6133
6134 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6135 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6136 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6137 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6138 @end deffn
6139
6140 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6141 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6142 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6143 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6144
6145 @example
6146 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6147 @end example
6148
6149 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6150 each single sector one by one.
6151
6152 @example
6153 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6154 @end example
6155
6156 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6157 @end deffn
6158
6159 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6160 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6161 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6162 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6163 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6164 starts at address 0.
6165
6166 @example
6167 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6168 @end example
6169 @end deffn
6170
6171 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6172 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6173 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6174 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6175 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6176 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6177 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6178 and programming the serial flash.
6179
6180 @example
6181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6182 @end example
6183 @end deffn
6184
6185 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6186 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6187 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6188 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6189 autoconfigures itself.
6190 @example
6191 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6192 @end example
6193 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6194 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6195 this via the following command:
6196 @example
6197 efm32 debuglock num
6198 @end example
6199 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6200 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6201 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6202 supported.}
6203 @end deffn
6204
6205 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6206 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6207 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6208 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6209 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6210 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6211
6212 @example
6213 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6214 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6215 @end example
6216
6217 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6218 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6219 @end deffn
6220
6221 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6222 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6223 is an uncommon operation.}
6224 @end deffn
6225 @end deffn
6226
6227 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6228 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6229 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6230 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6231 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6232 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6233 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6234
6235 @example
6236 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6237 @end example
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6241 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6242 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6243 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6244 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6245 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6246 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6247 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6248 characters) ignored.
6249
6250 @example
6251 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6252 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6253 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6254 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6255 @end example
6256 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6257 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6258 @end deffn
6259
6260 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6261 @cindex kinetis
6262 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6263 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6264 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6265 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6266 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6267 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6268
6269 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6270 @itemize
6271 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6272 @end itemize
6273
6274 @example
6275 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6276 @end example
6277
6278 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6279 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6280 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6281 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6285 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6286 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6287 set by 'flash protect' command.
6288 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6289 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6290 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6291 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6292 with the rest of a flash image.
6293 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6294 @end deffn
6295
6296 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6297 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6298 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6299 @end deffn
6300
6301 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6302 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6303 and examine-fail event.
6304 @end deffn
6305
6306 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6307 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6308 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6312 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6313 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6314 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6315 command completes.
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6319 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6320 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6321 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6322 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6323
6324 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6325 Program Partition command.
6326
6327 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6328 Reset the device after partition setting.
6329
6330 Show partition size:
6331 @example
6332 kinetis nvm_partition info
6333 @end example
6334
6335 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6336 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6337 @example
6338 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6339 @end example
6340
6341 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6342 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6343 @example
6344 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6345 @end example
6346 @end deffn
6347
6348 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6349 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6350 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6351 @end deffn
6352
6353 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6354 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6355 Command disables watchdog timer.
6356 @end deffn
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6360 @cindex kinetis_ke
6361 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6362 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6363 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6364 autoconfigures itself.
6365 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6366
6367 @example
6368 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6369 @end example
6370
6371 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6372 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6373 @end deffn
6374
6375 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6376 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6377 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6378 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6379 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6380 @end deffn
6381
6382 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6383 Command disables watchdog timer.
6384 @end deffn
6385 @end deffn
6386
6387 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6388 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6389 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6390 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6391 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6392
6393 @quotation Note
6394 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6395 driver:
6396 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6397 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6398 @end quotation
6399
6400 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6401 which must appear in the following order:
6402
6403 @itemize
6404 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6405 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6406 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6407 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6408 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6409 LPC43x[2357])
6410 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6411 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6412 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6413 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6414 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6415 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6416 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6417 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6418 at which the core is running
6419 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6420 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6421 @quotation Note
6422 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6423 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6424 However, if you do provide it,
6425 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6426 @end quotation
6427 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6428 ROM IAP entry point.
6429 @end itemize
6430
6431 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6432
6433 @example
6434 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6435 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6436 @end example
6437
6438 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6439 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6440 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6441 @end deffn
6442 @end deffn
6443
6444 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6445 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6446 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6447 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6448 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6449 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6450
6451 @example
6452 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6453 @end example
6454 @end deffn
6455
6456 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6457 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6458 from NXP.
6459
6460 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6461 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6462 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6463 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6464 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6465 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6466 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6467 you start the PLL.
6468
6469 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6470
6471 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6472 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6473 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6474
6475 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6476 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6477 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6478 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6479 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6480 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6481 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6482
6483 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6484 @example
6485 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6486 @end example
6487
6488 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6489 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6490 @code{flash banks} command.
6491
6492 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6493 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6494 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6495 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6496 a known signature.
6497 Example:
6498 @example
6499 lpc2900 signature 0
6500 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6501 @end example
6502 @end deffn
6503
6504 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6505 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6506 saves it to a file in binary format.
6507 Example:
6508 @example
6509 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6510 @end example
6511 @end deffn
6512
6513 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6514 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6515 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6516 command:
6517
6518 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6519 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6520 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6521 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6522
6523 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6524 Example:
6525 @example
6526 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6527 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6528 @end example
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6532 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6533 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6534 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6535 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6536 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6537 912 bytes.
6538 @quotation Attention
6539 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6540 @end quotation
6541 Example:
6542 @example
6543 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6544 @end example
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6548 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6549 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6550 after the next power cycle.
6551 @quotation Attention
6552 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6553 @end quotation
6554 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6555 Example:
6556 @example
6557 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6558 flash info 0
6559 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6560 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6561 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6562 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6563 @end example
6564 @end deffn
6565
6566 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6567 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6568 effective after the next power cycle.
6569 @quotation Attention
6570 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6571 @end quotation
6572 Examples:
6573 @example
6574 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6575 @end example
6576 @end deffn
6577 @end deffn
6578
6579 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6580 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6581 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6582 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6583
6584 @example
6585 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6586 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6587 @end example
6588
6589 @itemize @bullet
6590 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6591 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6592 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6593 @end itemize
6594
6595 Example usage:
6596 @example
6597 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6598 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6599 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6600 @} else @{
6601 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6602 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6603 @}
6604 @end example
6605 @end deffn
6606
6607 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6608 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6609 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6610 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6611 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6612 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6613
6614 @example
6615 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6616 @end example
6617
6618 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6619 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6620 only the main program flash.
6621
6622 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6623 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6624 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6625 @end deffn
6626
6627 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6628 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6629 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6630 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6631
6632 To erase and program the BSL:
6633 @example
6634 msp432 bsl unlock
6635 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6636 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6637 msp432 bsl lock
6638 @end example
6639 @end deffn
6640 @end deffn
6641
6642 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6643 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6644 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6645 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6646 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6647 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6648 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6649 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6650 also have division into regions: main and info.
6651 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6652 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6653
6654 @example
6655 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6656 @end example
6657
6658 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6659
6660 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6661 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6665 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6669 Erase all userflash including info region.
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6673 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6674 @end deffn
6675
6676 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6677 Check sectors protect.
6678 @end deffn
6679
6680 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6681 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6685 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6689 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6693 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6697 Show information about flash driver.
6698 @end deffn
6699
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6703 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6704 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6705 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6706 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6707
6708 @example
6709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6710 @end example
6711
6712 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6713
6714 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6715 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6716 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6717 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6718 code.
6719 @end deffn
6720
6721 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6722 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @end deffn
6726
6727 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6728 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6729 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6730
6731 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6732 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6733 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6734 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6735
6736 @example
6737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6738 @end example
6739 @end deffn
6740
6741 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6742 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6743 and integrate flash memory.
6744
6745 @example
6746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6748 @end example
6749
6750 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6751 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6752 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6753 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6754 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6755 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6756 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6757 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6758 @end deffn
6759 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6760 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6761 This will remove any Code Protection.
6762 @end deffn
6763 @end deffn
6764
6765 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6766 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6767 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6768 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6769 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6770
6771 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6772 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6773
6774 @example
6775 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6776 @end example
6777
6778 psoc4-specific commands
6779 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6780 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6781
6782 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6783 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6784
6785 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6786 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6787 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6788
6789 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6790 @end deffn
6791
6792 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6793 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6794
6795 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6796 @end deffn
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6800 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6801 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6802 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6803 apart from the base address.
6804
6805 @example
6806 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6807 @end example
6808
6809 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6810 @quotation Attention
6811 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6812 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6813 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6814 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6815 @end quotation
6816
6817 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6818
6819 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6820 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6821 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6822 @end deffn
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6826 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6827 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6828 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6829 apart from the base address.
6830
6831 @example
6832 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6833 $_TARGETNAME
6834 @end example
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6838 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6839 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6840 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6844 @end example
6845
6846 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6847
6848 @itemize
6849 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6850 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6851 @end itemize
6852
6853 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6854
6855 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6856 @quotation Attention
6857 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6858 after successful write.
6859 @end quotation
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6863 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6864 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6865 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6866
6867 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6868 @itemize @bullet
6869 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6870 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6871 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6872 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6873 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6874 row size: 512 bytes.
6875 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6876 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6877 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6878 operation will erase row automatically.
6879 @end itemize
6880
6881 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6882 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6883
6884 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6885
6886 @example
6887 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6888 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6889 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6890 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6891 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6892 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6893 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6894 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6895 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6896 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6897 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6898 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6899
6900 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6901 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6902 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6903 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6904 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6905 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6906 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6907 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6908 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6909 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6910 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6911 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6912 @end example
6913
6914 psoc6-specific commands
6915 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6916 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6917 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6918 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6919 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6920 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6924 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6925 by @command{flash banks}.
6926 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6927 @end deffn
6928 @end deffn
6929
6930 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6931 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6932 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6933 and SWD interface.
6934 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6935 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6936
6937 @example
6938 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6939 @end example
6940
6941 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6942
6943 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6944 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6945 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6946 @end deffn
6947
6948 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6949 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6950 @end deffn
6951 @end deffn
6952
6953 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6954 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6955 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6956 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6957 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6958
6959 @example
6960 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6961 @end example
6962
6963 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6964 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6965 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6966 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6967 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6968 disabled.
6969
6970 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6971 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6972 @quotation Warning
6973 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6974 applied to all of them.
6975 @end quotation
6976 @end deffn
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6980 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6981 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6982 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6983 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6984
6985 @example
6986 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6987 @end example
6988
6989 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6990 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6991 the flash driver.
6992
6993 @example
6994 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6995 @end example
6996
6997 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6998 as per the following example.
6999 @example
7000 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7001 @end example
7002
7003 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7004
7005 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
7006 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7007 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
7011 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7012 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7013 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7017 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7018 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
7022 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7023 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7024 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7025 @end deffn
7026
7027 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7028 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7029 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7030 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
7034 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7035 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7036 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7037 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7038 @end deffn
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
7042 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7043 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7044 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7045 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7046
7047 @example
7048 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7049 @end example
7050
7051 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7052 as per the following example.
7053 @example
7054 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7055 @end example
7056
7057 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7058 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7059 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7060 @end deffn
7061
7062 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7063 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7064 the flash driver.
7065
7066 @example
7067 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7068 @end example
7069
7070 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7071
7072 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
7073 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7074 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
7078 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7079 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7083 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7084 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7085 @end deffn
7086
7087 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
7088 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7089 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7090 @end deffn
7091
7092 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7093 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7094 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7095 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7096 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7097 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7098 @end deffn
7099
7100 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7101 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7102 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7103 @end deffn
7104 @end deffn
7105
7106 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7107 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7108 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7109 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7110 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7111
7112 @example
7113 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7114 @end example
7115
7116 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7117 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7118 the flash driver.
7119
7120 @example
7121 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7122 @end example
7123
7124 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7125
7126 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7127 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7128 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7132 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7133 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7137 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7138 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7142 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7143 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7144 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7145 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7146
7147 Example usage:
7148 @example
7149 # read OPTSR_CUR
7150 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7151 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7152 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7153 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7154 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7155 @end example
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7159 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7160 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7161 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7162 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7163 will be touched).
7164
7165 Example usage:
7166 @example
7167 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7168 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7169 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7170 @end example
7171 @end deffn
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7175 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7176 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7177 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7178 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7179
7180 @example
7181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7182 @end example
7183
7184 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7185 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7186 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7187 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7188 second bank.
7189
7190 @example
7191 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7192 @end example
7193
7194 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7195
7196 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7197 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7198 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7202 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7203 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7204 @end deffn
7205
7206 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7207 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7208 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7209 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7210 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7211 @end deffn
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7215 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7216 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7217 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7218 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7219 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7220
7221 @example
7222 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7223 @end example
7224
7225 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7226 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7227 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7228 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7229
7230 @example
7231 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7232 @end example
7233
7234 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7235
7236 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7237 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7238 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7242 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7243 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7244 @end deffn
7245
7246 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7247 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7248 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7252 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7253 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7254 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7255
7256 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7257 @example
7258 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7259 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7260 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7261 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7262 @end example
7263
7264 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7265 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7266 @end deffn
7267
7268 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7269 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7270 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7271 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7272 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7273
7274 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7275 @example
7276 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7277 @end example
7278
7279 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7280 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7281 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7282 @end deffn
7283
7284 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7285 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7286 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7287 @end deffn
7288 @end deffn
7289
7290 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7291 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7292 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7293 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7294 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7295
7296 @example
7297 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7298 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7299 @end example
7300
7301 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7302 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7303 for the specified flash bank.
7304 @end deffn
7305 @end deffn
7306
7307 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7308 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7309 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7310 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7311 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7312
7313 @example
7314 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7315 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7316 @end example
7317
7318 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7319 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7320 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7321
7322 @itemize @bullet
7323 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7324 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7325 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7326 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7327 @end itemize
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @end deffn
7331
7332 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7333 @cindex str9xpec
7334
7335 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7336 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7337 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7338 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7339
7340 Here is some background info to help
7341 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7342 the str9:
7343 @enumerate
7344 @item
7345 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7346 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7347 @item
7348 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7349 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7350 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7351 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7352 @end enumerate
7353
7354 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7355 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7356 configured for flash bank 0.
7357 @example
7358 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7359 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7360 adapter assert srst
7361 # turn off target polling
7362 poll off
7363 # disable str9 core
7364 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7365 # read option bytes
7366 str9xpec options_read 0
7367 # re-enable str9 core
7368 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7369 poll on
7370 reset halt
7371 @end example
7372 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7373 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7374 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7375 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7376
7377 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7378
7379 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7380 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7381 @end deffn
7382
7383 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7384 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7385 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7389 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7390 erase the device.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7394 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7398 Configure str9 boot bank.
7399 @end deffn
7400
7401 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7402 Configure str9 lvd source.
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7406 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7410 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7414 Read str9 option bytes.
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7418 Write str9 option bytes.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7422 unlock str9 device.
7423 @end deffn
7424
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7428 @cindex swm050
7429 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7430
7431 @example
7432 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7433 @end example
7434
7435 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7436
7437 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7438 Erases the entire flash bank.
7439 @end deffn
7440
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443
7444 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7445 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7446 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7447 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7448
7449 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7450
7451 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7452 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7453 @end deffn
7454
7455 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7456 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7457 @end deffn
7458
7459 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7460 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7461 the flash clock.
7462 @end deffn
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7466 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7467 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7468 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7469 correct bank config.
7470
7471 @example
7472 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7473 @end example
7474 @end deffn
7475
7476 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7477 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7478 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7479 @end deffn
7480
7481 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7482 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7483 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7484
7485 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7486
7487 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7488 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7492 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7493 @end deffn
7494
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @section NAND Flash Commands
7498 @cindex NAND
7499
7500 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7501 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7502 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7503
7504 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7505 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7506 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7507 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7508 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7509 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7510
7511 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7512 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7513 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7514 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7515 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7516 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7517 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7518 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7519 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7520 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7521
7522 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7523 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7524 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7525 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7526 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7527 every 512 bytes of data.
7528
7529 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7530 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7531 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7532 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7533 ECC mode is used.
7534
7535 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7536 @enumerate
7537 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7538 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7539 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7540 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7541 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7542 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7543 to access that device.
7544 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7545 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7546 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7547 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7548 de-brick a board.
7549 @end enumerate
7550
7551 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7552 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7553 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7554 are only 32 bits wide.
7555 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7556 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7557 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7558 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7559
7560 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7561 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7562 @cindex NAND configuration
7563
7564 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7565 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7566 OpenOCD has initialized.
7567
7568 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7569 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7570 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7571 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7572 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7573 they were a single (larger) device.
7574 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7575 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7576
7577 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7578 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7579 configuration files, not interactively.
7580
7581 @itemize @bullet
7582 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7583 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7584 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7585 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7586 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7587 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7588 commands to the NAND controller.
7589 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7590 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7591 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7592 for more information.
7593 @end itemize
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn Command {nand list}
7597 Prints a summary of each device declared
7598 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7599 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7600 @example
7601 > nand list
7602 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7603 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7604 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7605 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7606 >
7607 @end example
7608 @end deffn
7609
7610 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7611 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7612 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7613 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7614 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7615 it with most other NAND commands.
7616 @end deffn
7617
7618 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7619
7620 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7621 @cindex NAND reading
7622 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7623 starting at the specified offset.
7624 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7625
7626 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7627 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7628
7629 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7630 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7631 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7632
7633 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7634 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7635 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7636 method which handled that error correction.
7637
7638 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7639 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7640 @itemize @bullet
7641 @item no oob_* parameter
7642 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7643 @item @code{oob_raw}
7644 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7645 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7646 spare areas associated with each data page.
7647 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7648 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7649 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7650 @item @code{oob_only}
7651 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7652 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7653 spare areas associated with each data page.
7654 @end itemize
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7658 @cindex NAND erasing
7659 @cindex NAND programming
7660 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7661 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7662 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7663 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7664 If those parameters are not specified,
7665 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7666 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7667
7668 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7669 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7670 block marker.
7671 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7672 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7676 @cindex NAND writing
7677 @cindex NAND programming
7678 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7679 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7680 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7681 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7682
7683 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7684 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7685
7686 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7687 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7688 past the end of the device.
7689 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7690 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7691 if that's being written.)
7692
7693 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7694 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7695 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7696
7697 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7698 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7699 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7700 @itemize @bullet
7701 @item no oob_* parameter
7702 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7703 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7704 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7705 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7706 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7707 @item @code{oob_only}
7708 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7709 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7710 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7711 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7712 @item @code{oob_raw}
7713 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7714 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7715 un-altered OOB.
7716 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7717 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7718 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7719 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7720 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7721 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7722 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7723 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7724 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7725 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7726 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7727 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7728 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7729 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7730 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7731 @end itemize
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7735 @cindex NAND verification
7736 @cindex NAND programming
7737 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7738 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7739 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7740
7741 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7742 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7743
7744 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7745 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7746 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7747 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7748 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7749
7750 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7751 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7752 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7753
7754 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7755 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7756 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7757 be removed in a future release.
7758 @end deffn
7759
7760 @subsection Other NAND commands
7761 @cindex NAND other commands
7762
7763 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7764 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7765 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7766 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7767 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7768 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7769 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7770 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7771
7772 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7773 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7774 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7775 @end deffn
7776
7777 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7778 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7779 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7780 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7781 status for each block.
7782 @end deffn
7783
7784 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7785 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7786 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7787
7788 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7789 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7790 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7791 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7792 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7793
7794 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7795 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7796 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7797 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7798 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7799 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7800 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7801 @end deffn
7802
7803 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7804 @subsection NAND Driver List
7805 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7806 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7807 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7808
7809 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7810 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7811 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7812 address of the ECC controller.
7813 @example
7814 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7815 @end example
7816 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7817 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7818 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7819 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7820 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7821 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7822 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7823 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7824 @end deffn
7825 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7826 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7827 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7828 @end deffn
7829
7830 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7831 properly configured for input or output.
7832 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7833 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7834 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7835 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7836 @end deffn
7837 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7838 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7839 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7840 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7841 @end deffn
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7845 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7846 chips from Texas Instruments.
7847 It takes three extra parameters:
7848 address of the NAND chip;
7849 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7850 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7851 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7852 @example
7853 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7854 @end example
7855 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7856 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7857 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7858 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7859 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7860 @end deffn
7861
7862 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7863 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7864 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7865 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7866 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7867 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7868 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7872 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7873 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7874 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7875 @end deffn
7876 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7877
7878 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7879 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7880 should work for this chip as well.
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7884 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7885 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7886 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7887 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7888 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7889 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7890 @example
7891 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7892 @end example
7893 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7894 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7895 without parameter query status.
7896 @end deffn
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7900 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7901 parameter: the address of the controller.
7902 @example
7903 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7904 @end example
7905 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7906 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7907 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7908 change any behavior.
7909 @end deffn
7910
7911 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7912 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7913 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7914 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7915 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7916 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7917 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7918 specialized commands.
7919 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7920 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7921 change any behavior.
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924 @node Flash Programming
7925 @chapter Flash Programming
7926
7927 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7928 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7929 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7930
7931 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7932 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7933
7934 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7935 @enumerate
7936 @item 'init' is executed.
7937 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7938 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7939 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7940 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7941 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7942 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7943 @end enumerate
7944
7945 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7946
7947 @example
7948 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7949 # are optional parameters
7950 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7951 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7952
7953 # binary files need the flash address passing
7954 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7955 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7956 @end example
7957
7958 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7959 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7960 @cindex PLD
7961 @cindex FPGA
7962
7963 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7964 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7965 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7966 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7967 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7968 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7969 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7970
7971 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7972
7973 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7974 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7975 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7976
7977 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7978 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7979
7980 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7981 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7982 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7983 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7984 behavior.
7985 @end deffn
7986
7987 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7988 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7989 @end deffn
7990
7991 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7992 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7993 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7994 @end deffn
7995
7996 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7997
7998 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7999 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8000 that particular type of PLD.
8001
8002 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
8003 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8004 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8005
8006 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8007 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8008 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8009
8010 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8011 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8012 for FPGA @var{num}.
8013 @end deffn
8014 @end deffn
8015
8016 @node General Commands
8017 @chapter General Commands
8018 @cindex commands
8019
8020 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8021 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8022 commands are documented elsewhere.
8023
8024 Intent:
8025 @itemize @bullet
8026 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8027 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8028 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8029 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8030
8031 @item @b{From the human}
8032 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8033 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8034
8035 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8036 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8037 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8038
8039 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8040 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8041 port is 5555.
8042 @end itemize
8043
8044
8045 @section Server Commands
8046
8047 @deffn {Command} exit
8048 Exits the current telnet session.
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 @deffn {Command} help [string]
8052 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8053 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8054 Not every command provides helptext.
8055
8056 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8057 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8058 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8059 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
8063 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8064 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8065 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8066 Useful in connection with script files
8067 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
8071 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8072 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8073 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8074
8075 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8076 @example
8077 # redefine shutdown
8078 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8079 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8080 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8081 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8082 original_shutdown
8083 @}
8084 @end example
8085 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8086 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 @anchor{debuglevel}
8090 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
8091 @cindex message level
8092 Display debug level.
8093 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8094 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8095 Level 0 is error messages only;
8096 level 1 adds warnings;
8097 level 2 adds informational messages;
8098 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8099 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8100 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8101 the command line along with the location of that log
8102 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8103 @xref{Running}.
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8107 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8108 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8109 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8110 @example
8111 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8112 @end example
8113 @end deffn
8114
8115 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8116 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8117 the default log output channel is stderr.
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8121 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8122 @end deffn
8123
8124 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8125 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8126 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8127 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8128 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8129 @end deffn
8130
8131 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8132 @section Target State handling
8133 @cindex reset
8134 @cindex halt
8135 @cindex target initialization
8136
8137 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8138 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8139 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8140 a current target which is used to perform the
8141 various operations. The current target may be changed
8142 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8143 target which should become current.
8144
8145 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8146 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8147 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8148 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8149 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8150
8151 @emph{With no arguments}:
8152 list all available registers for the current target,
8153 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8154 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8155 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8156 are flagged as such.
8157
8158 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8159 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8160 bypassing any internal cache.
8161
8162 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8163 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8164 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8165 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8166 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8167 relevant module will flush such values.
8168
8169 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8170 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8171
8172 @example
8173 > reg
8174 ===== ARM registers
8175 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8176 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8177 (2) r2 (/32)
8178 ...
8179 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8180 >
8181 @end example
8182 @end deffn
8183
8184 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8185 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8186 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8187 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8188 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8189 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8190 (and enter debug mode).
8191 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8192
8193 @quotation Warning
8194 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8195 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8196 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8197 power mode by gating the core clock;
8198 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8199
8200 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8201 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8202 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8203 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8204 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8205 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8206
8207 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8208 work with a JTAG debugger.
8209 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8210 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8211 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8212 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8213 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8214 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8215 @end quotation
8216
8217 @end deffn
8218
8219 @deffn Command resume [address]
8220 Resume the target at its current code position,
8221 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8222 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8223 @end deffn
8224
8225 @deffn Command step [address]
8226 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8227 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8228 @end deffn
8229
8230 @anchor{resetcommand}
8231 @deffn Command reset
8232 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8233 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8234 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8235 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8236 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8237 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8238
8239 The optional parameter specifies what should
8240 happen after the reset.
8241 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8242 The other options will not work on all systems.
8243 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8244
8245 @itemize @minus
8246 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8247 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8248 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8249 @end itemize
8250 @end deffn
8251
8252 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8253 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8254 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8255 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8256 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8257 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8258 state.
8259 @end deffn
8260
8261 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8262 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8263 Set values of reset signals.
8264 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8265 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8266 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8267 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8268
8269 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8270 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8271 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8272 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8273 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8274 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8275 the signal will not be modified.
8276
8277 @quotation Note
8278 TRST is specially handled.
8279 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8280 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8281 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8282 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8283 instead of the TRST signal.
8284 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8285 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8286 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8287 with handlers for that event.
8288 @end quotation
8289 @end deffn
8290
8291 @section I/O Utilities
8292
8293 These commands are available when
8294 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8295 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8296 notably the ZY1000.
8297 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8298
8299 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8300
8301 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8302 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8303 the text file @file{filename}.
8304 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8305 The last string is followed by a newline.
8306 @end deffn
8307
8308 @deffn Command cat filename
8309 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8310 @end deffn
8311
8312 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8313 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8314 into @file{dest_filename}.
8315 @end deffn
8316
8317 @deffn Command ip
8318 @emph{No description provided.}
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @deffn Command ls
8322 @emph{No description provided.}
8323 @end deffn
8324
8325 @deffn Command mac
8326 @emph{No description provided.}
8327 @end deffn
8328
8329 @deffn Command meminfo
8330 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8331 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8332 @end deffn
8333
8334 @deffn Command peek
8335 @emph{No description provided.}
8336 @end deffn
8337
8338 @deffn Command poke
8339 @emph{No description provided.}
8340 @end deffn
8341
8342 @deffn Command rm filename
8343 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8344 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8345 @end deffn
8346
8347 @deffn Command trunc filename
8348 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8349 @end deffn
8350
8351 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8352 @section Memory access commands
8353 @cindex memory access
8354
8355 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8356 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8357 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8358 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8359
8360 @enumerate
8361 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8362 to change the current target.
8363 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8364 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8365 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8366 @end enumerate
8367
8368 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8369 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8370 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8371 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8372 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8373 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8374 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8375 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8376 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8377 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8378 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8379 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8380 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8381 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8382 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8386 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8387 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8388 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8389 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8390 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8391 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8392 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8393 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8394 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8395 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8396 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @anchor{imageaccess}
8400 @section Image loading commands
8401 @cindex image loading
8402 @cindex image dumping
8403
8404 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8405 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8406 binary file named @var{filename}.
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8410 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8411 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8412 @end deffn
8413
8414 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8415 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8416 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8417 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8418 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8419 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8420 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8421 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8422 separately.
8423 @end deffn
8424
8425 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8426 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8427 The file format may optionally be specified
8428 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8429 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8430 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8431 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8432 @example
8433 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8434 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8435 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8436 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8437 $address $length
8438 @}
8439 @end example
8440 @end deffn
8441
8442 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8443 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8444 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8445 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8446 The file format may optionally be specified
8447 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8448 @end deffn
8449
8450 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8451 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8452 The file format may optionally be specified
8453 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8454 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8458 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8459 The file format may optionally be specified
8460 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8461 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8462 @end deffn
8463
8464
8465 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8466 @cindex breakpoint
8467 @cindex watchpoint
8468
8469 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8470 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8471 watchpoints.
8472 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8473
8474 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8475 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8476 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8477 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8478 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8479 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8480
8481 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8482 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8483 @end deffn
8484
8485 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8486 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8490 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8491 @end deffn
8492
8493 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8494 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8495 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8496 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8497 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8498 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8499 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8500 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8501 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8502 @end deffn
8503
8504
8505 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8506
8507 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8508 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8509 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8510 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8511 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8512 running, can be used.
8513 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8514 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8515 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8516
8517 @quotation Note
8518 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8519 @end quotation
8520
8521 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8522 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8523 communication, respectively.
8524
8525 @quotation Note
8526 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8527 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8528 example.
8529 @end quotation
8530
8531 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8532 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8533 of TCP/IP connections.
8534
8535 @deffn Command {rtt setup} address size ID
8536 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8537 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8538 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8539 @var{size} bytes.
8540 @end deffn
8541
8542 @deffn Command {rtt start}
8543 Start RTT.
8544 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {rtt stop}
8548 Stop RTT.
8549 @end deffn
8550
8551 @deffn Command {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8552 Display the polling interval.
8553 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8554 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8555 checked for new data.
8556 @end deffn
8557
8558 @deffn Command {rtt channels}
8559 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8560 @end deffn
8561
8562 @deffn Command {rtt channellist}
8563 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8564 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @deffn Command {rtt server start} port channel
8568 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn Command {rtt server stop} port
8572 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8576 on the target device.
8577
8578 @example
8579 resume
8580
8581 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8582 rtt start
8583
8584 rtt server start 9090 0
8585 @end example
8586
8587 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8588 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8589 TCP/IP port 9090.
8590
8591
8592 @section Misc Commands
8593
8594 @cindex profiling
8595 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8596 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8597 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8598 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8599 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8600 limit the address range.
8601 @end deffn
8602
8603 @deffn Command {version}
8604 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8605 @end deffn
8606
8607 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8608 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8609 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8610 @end deffn
8611
8612 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8613 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8614 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8615 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8616
8617 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8618 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8619 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8620 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8621
8622 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8623 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8624 @cindex tracing
8625 @cindex ETM
8626 @cindex ETB
8627
8628 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8629 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8630 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8631
8632 @itemize
8633 @item
8634 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8635 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8636 supports such an interface.
8637 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8638 and trace port support.)
8639 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8640 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8641 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8642 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8643 in the board-specific configuration file.
8644 @item
8645 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8646 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8647 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8648 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8649 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8650 @end itemize
8651
8652 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8653
8654 @quotation Issues
8655 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8656 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8657
8658 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8659 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8660 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8661 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8662 dummy trace port driver}.
8663
8664 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8665 as well as tracing only during specific states
8666 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8667
8668 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8669 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8670 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8671 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8672 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8673
8674 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8675 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8676 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8677 this original style of JTAG access.
8678 @end quotation
8679
8680 @subsection ETM Configuration
8681 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8682
8683 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8684 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8685 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8686
8687 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8688 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8689 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8690 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8691 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8692 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8693 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8694 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8695 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8696
8697 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8698 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8699 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8700
8701 @quotation Warning
8702 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8703 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8704 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8705 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8706 @end quotation
8707
8708 @quotation Note
8709 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8710 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8711 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8712 what CPU activities are traced.
8713 @end quotation
8714 @end deffn
8715
8716 @deffn Command {etm info}
8717 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8718 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8719 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8720 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8721 @end deffn
8722
8723 @deffn Command {etm status}
8724 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8725 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8726 Did trace data overflow?
8727 Was it triggered?
8728 @end deffn
8729
8730 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8731 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8732 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8733 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8734 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8735
8736 @itemize
8737 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8738 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8739 The value is one of
8740 @option{none} (save nothing),
8741 @option{data} (save data),
8742 @option{address} (save addresses),
8743 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8744 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8745 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8746 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8747 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8748 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8749 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8750 trace stream without an image of the code.
8751 @end itemize
8752 @end deffn
8753
8754 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8755 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8756 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8757 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8758 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8759
8760 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8761 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8762 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8763 @end deffn
8764
8765 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8766
8767 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8768 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8769 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8770
8771 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8772 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8773 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8774 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8775 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8776 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8777 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8778
8779 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8780
8781 @itemize
8782 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8783 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8784 for instruction access within that function's body.
8785 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8786 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8787 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8788 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8789 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8790 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8791 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8792 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8793 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8794 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8795 @item @emph{... more}
8796 @end itemize
8797
8798 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8799 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8800
8801 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8802 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8803 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8807 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8808 @end deffn
8809
8810 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8811 Opens an image file.
8812 @end deffn
8813
8814 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8815 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8816 @end deffn
8817
8818 @deffn Command {etm start}
8819 Starts trace data collection.
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8823 Stops trace data collection.
8824 @end deffn
8825
8826 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8827 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8828
8829 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8830
8831 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8832 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8833 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8834 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8835 any trace data collection.}
8836 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8837 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8838 @end deffn
8839 @end deffn
8840
8841 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8842 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8843 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8844 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8845 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8846 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8847 @end deffn
8848 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8849 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8850 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8851 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8852 trace trigger becomes active.
8853
8854 @itemize
8855 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8856 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8857 afterwards.
8858 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8859 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8860 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8861 what caused that event to happen.
8862 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8863 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8864 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8865 how the event caused trouble.
8866 @end itemize
8867 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8868 @end deffn
8869
8870 @end deffn
8871
8872 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8873 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8874 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8875 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8876 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8877
8878 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8879 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8880
8881 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8882 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8883 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8884 @end deffn
8885
8886 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8887 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8888 @end deffn
8889
8890 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8891 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8892 @end deffn
8893 @end deffn
8894
8895 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8896 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8897 @cindex CTI
8898
8899 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8900 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8901 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8902 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8903 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8904 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8905
8906 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8907 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8908 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8909 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8910 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8911 including additional configuration.
8912 @end deffn
8913
8914 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8915 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8916 @end deffn
8917
8918 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8919 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8920 @end deffn
8921
8922 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8923 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8924 @end deffn
8925
8926 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8927 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8931 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8932 @end deffn
8933
8934 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8935 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8936 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8937 @end deffn
8938
8939 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8940 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8941 of the CTI.
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn Command {cti names}
8945 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8946 useful in TCL scripting.
8947 @end deffn
8948
8949 @section Generic ARM
8950 @cindex ARM
8951
8952 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8953 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8954 commands that may be available.
8955
8956 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8957 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8958 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8959 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8960 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8961 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8962 @end deffn
8963
8964 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8965 @cindex disassemble
8966 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8967 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8968 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8969 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8970 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8971 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8972 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8973
8974 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8975 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8976 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8977 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8978 with a handful of exceptions.
8979 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8980 @end deffn
8981
8982 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8983 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8984 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8985 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8986 and using the MCR instruction.
8987 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8988 an ARM register.)
8989 @end deffn
8990
8991 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8992 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8993 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8994 and the MRC instruction.
8995 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8996 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8997 an ARM register.)
8998 @end deffn
8999
9000 @deffn Command {arm reg}
9001 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9002 core mode if necessary.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9006 @cindex ARM semihosting
9007 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9008
9009 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9010 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9011 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9012 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9013 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9014 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9015 @end deffn
9016
9017 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9018 @cindex ARM semihosting
9019 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9020
9021 @example
9022 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9023 @end example
9024
9025 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9026 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9027 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9028 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9032 @cindex ARM semihosting
9033 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9034 status.
9035
9036 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9037 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9038 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9039 debugger.
9040 @end deffn
9041
9042 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9043 @cindex ARM semihosting
9044 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9045
9046 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9047 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9048 the value returned by the target.
9049
9050 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9051 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9052 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9053 encountering a break.
9054
9055 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9056 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9057 to the debugger.
9058 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9059 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9060 request or equivalent").
9061
9062 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9063 this option (default: disabled).
9064 @end deffn
9065
9066 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9067 @cindex ARMv4
9068 @cindex ARMv5
9069
9070 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9071 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9072 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9073 variant.
9074
9075 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9076 @cindex ARM7
9077 @cindex ARM9
9078
9079 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9080 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9081 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9082 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9083
9084 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9085 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9086 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9087 instead of breakpoints.
9088 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9089
9090 This should be
9091 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9092 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9093 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9094 @end deffn
9095
9096 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9097 @cindex DCC
9098 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9099 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9100 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9101
9102 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9103 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9104 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9108 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9109 that don't check completion of the operation.
9110 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9111
9112 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9113 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9114 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
9118 @cindex ARM720T
9119
9120 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
9121 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9122 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
9123 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
9124
9125 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
9126 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9127 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9128
9129 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
9130 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9131 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9135 @cindex ARM9
9136
9137 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9138 integer processors.
9139 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9140
9141 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9142 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9143 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9144 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9145
9146 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9147 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9148 @cindex vector_catch
9149 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9150 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9151 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9152 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9153 to those hardware vectors.
9154
9155 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9156 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9157 vector catch hardware to intercept
9158 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9159 @option{none} of them,
9160 or a list with one or more of the following:
9161 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9162 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9166 @cindex ARM920T
9167
9168 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9169 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9170 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9171 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9172 and ARM9 commands.
9173
9174 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
9175 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9176 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9180 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9181 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9182 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9183 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9184 (Not all registers can be written.)
9185 @end deffn
9186
9187 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
9188 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
9189 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
9190
9191 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
9192 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
9193 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
9194 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
9195 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
9196 or using zero if no other address is provided.
9197 @end deffn
9198
9199 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9200 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9204 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9205 @end deffn
9206
9207 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9208 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9209
9210 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9211 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9212 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9213 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9214 and ARM9 commands.
9215
9216 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9217 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9218
9219 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9220 Print information about the caches found.
9221 @end deffn
9222
9223 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9224 @cindex ARM966E
9225
9226 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9227 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9228 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9229 and ARM9 commands.
9230
9231 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9232 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9233 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9234 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9235 ARM966E-S TRM.
9236 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9237 as required for BIST support.
9238 @end deffn
9239
9240 @subsection XScale specific commands
9241 @cindex XScale
9242
9243 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9244
9245 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9246 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9247 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9248 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9249 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9250 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9251 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9252
9253 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9254 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9255 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9256 the mini-IC.
9257
9258 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9259 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9260 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9261 code layout in memory:
9262 @example
9263 _vectors:
9264 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9265 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9266 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9267 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9268 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9269 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9270 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9271 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9272 .org 0x100
9273 .long real_reset_vector
9274 .long real_ui_handler
9275 .long real_swi_handler
9276 .long real_pf_abort
9277 .long real_data_abort
9278 .long 0 /* unused */
9279 .long real_irq_handler
9280 .long real_fiq_handler
9281 @end example
9282
9283 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9284 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9285 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9286 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9287 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9288 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9289 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9290 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9291 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9292 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9293 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9294 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9295 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9296 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9297 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9298 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9299 software.
9300
9301 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9302 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9303 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9304 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9305
9306 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9307 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9308 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9309 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9310 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9311 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9312 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9313 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9314 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9315
9316 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9317 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9318
9319 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9320 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9321 @end deffn
9322
9323 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9324 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9325 @end deffn
9326
9327 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9328 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9329 @end deffn
9330
9331 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9332 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9333 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9337 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9338 @end deffn
9339
9340 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9341 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9342 @end deffn
9343
9344 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9345 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9346 @end deffn
9347
9348 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9349 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9350 @end deffn
9351
9352 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9353 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9354 @end deffn
9355
9356 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9357 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9358 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9359 and modifying how it is emptied.
9360 @end deffn
9361
9362 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9363 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9364 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9365 The image @var{type} may be one of
9366 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9367 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9368 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9369 @end deffn
9370
9371 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9372 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9373 @cindex vector_catch
9374 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9375 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9376
9377 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9378 @example
9379 0x01 Trap Reset
9380 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9381 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9382 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9383 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9384 0x20 reserved
9385 0x40 Trap IRQ
9386 0x80 Trap FIQ
9387 @end example
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9391 @cindex vector_table
9392
9393 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9394 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9395 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9396 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9397 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9398
9399 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9400
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9404 @cindex ARMv6
9405
9406 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9407 @cindex ARM11
9408
9409 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9410 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9411 which is enabled by default.
9412 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9413 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9414 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9415 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9416 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9417 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9418 @end deffn
9419
9420 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9421 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9422 which is enabled by default.
9423 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9424 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9428 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9429 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9430 they are disabled by default.
9431 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9435 @cindex vector_catch
9436 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9437 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9438 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9439
9440 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9441 for certain hardware events.
9442 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9443 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9444 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9445 @end deffn
9446
9447 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9448 @cindex ARMv7
9449 @cindex ARMv8
9450
9451 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9452 @cindex Cortex-A
9453
9454 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9455 display information about target caches
9456 @end deffn
9457
9458 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9459 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9460 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9461 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9462 Defaults to 'off'.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9466 Initialize core debug
9467 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9471 Display/set the current SMP mode
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9475 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9476 @end deffn
9477
9478 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9479 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9483 configure l2x cache
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9487 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9488 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9489 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9490 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9491 @end deffn
9492
9493 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9494 @cindex Cortex-R
9495
9496 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9497 Initialize core debug
9498 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9499 @end deffn
9500
9501 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9502 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505
9506 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9507 @cindex tracing
9508 @cindex SWO
9509 @cindex SWV
9510 @cindex TPIU
9511
9512 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9513 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9514 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9515 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9516
9517 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9518 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9519 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9520 which causes quite some confusion.
9521 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9522 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9523
9524 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9525 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9526 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9527
9528 @deffn Command {swo} ...
9529 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9530 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9531 @end deffn
9532
9533 @deffn Command {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9534 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9535 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9536 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9537
9538 @itemize @bullet
9539 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9540 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9541 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9542 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9543
9544 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9545 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9546 @end itemize
9547 @end deffn
9548
9549 @deffn Command {tpiu names}
9550 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9551 @end deffn
9552
9553 @deffn Command {tpiu init}
9554 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9555 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9556 at any time after the initialization, too.
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9560 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9561 individually queried, to return its current value.
9562 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9563 @end deffn
9564
9565 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9566 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9567 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9568 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9569
9570 @itemize @bullet
9571 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9572 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9573
9574 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9575 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9576
9577 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9578 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9579
9580 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9581 protocol used for trace data:
9582 @itemize @minus
9583 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9584 data bits (default);
9585 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9586 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9587 @end itemize
9588
9589 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9590 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9591 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9592 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9593 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9594 of the TPIU.
9595
9596 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9597 the destination of the trace data:
9598 @itemize @minus
9599 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9600 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9601 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9602 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9603 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9604 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9605 each connected client;
9606 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9607 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9608 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9609 @end itemize
9610
9611 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9612 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9613 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9614 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9615
9616 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9617 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9618 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9619 maximum supported rate automatically.
9620
9621 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9622 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9623 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9624
9625 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9626 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9627 default value is @var{0}.
9628 @end itemize
9629 @end deffn
9630
9631 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name enable}
9632 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9633 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9634 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9635 data.
9636 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9637 after the @command{init}.
9638 @end deffn
9639
9640 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name disable}
9641 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9642 @end deffn
9643
9644
9645 TODO: remove the old tpiu commands
9646
9647 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)}) @
9648 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9649 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9650
9651 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9652 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9653 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9654 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9655
9656 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9657 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9658 debugger adapter features.
9659
9660 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9661 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9662
9663 Command options:
9664 @itemize @minus
9665 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9666 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9667 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware).
9668 @item @option{internal (@var{filename} | @var{:port} | -)} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9669 gather trace data then:
9670
9671 @itemize @minus
9672 @item append it to a regular file or a named pipe if @var{filename} is specified.
9673 @item listen to a TCP/IP port if @var{:port} is specified, then broadcast the trace data over this port.
9674 @item if '-' is specified, OpenOCD will forward trace data to @command{tcl_trace} command.
9675 @*@b{Note:} while broadcasting to file or TCP, the forwarding to @command{tcl_trace} will remain active.
9676 @end itemize
9677
9678 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9679 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width}.
9680 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9681 coding.
9682 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9683 regular UART 8N1) coding.
9684 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9685 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9686 data is to be output via SWO.
9687 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9688 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK).
9689 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9690 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9691 rate automatically.
9692 @end itemize
9693
9694 Example usage:
9695 @enumerate
9696 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9697 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9698 enough to:
9699 @example
9700 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9701 ...
9702 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9703 ...
9704 @end example
9705 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9706 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9707 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9708 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9709 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9710 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9711 @example
9712 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9713 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9714 @end example
9715 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9716 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9717 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9718 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9719 @example
9720 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9721 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9722 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9723 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9724 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9725 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9726 @end example
9727 @end enumerate
9728 @end deffn
9729
9730 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9731 @cindex tracing
9732 @cindex SWO
9733 @cindex SWV
9734 @cindex ITM
9735 @cindex ETM
9736
9737 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9738 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9739 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9740 @end deffn
9741
9742 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9743 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9744 @end deffn
9745
9746 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9747 @cindex Cortex-M
9748
9749 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9750 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9751
9752 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9753 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9754 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9755 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9756 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9757 the step command leaves with the core running.
9758
9759 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9760 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9761 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9762 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9763
9764 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9765 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9766 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9767 does.
9768
9769 Default is @option{auto}.
9770 @end deffn
9771
9772 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9773 @cindex vector_catch
9774 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9775 for certain hardware events.
9776
9777 Parameters request interception of
9778 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9779 @option{none} of them,
9780 or one or more of the following:
9781 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9782 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9783 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9784 @option{irq_err},
9785 @option{state_err},
9786 @option{chk_err}, or
9787 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9788 @option{reset}.
9789 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9790 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9791 are mapped to HardFault.
9792 UsageFault checks for
9793 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9794 must also be explicitly enabled.
9795
9796 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9797 @end deffn
9798
9799 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9800 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9801 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9802
9803 @itemize @minus
9804 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9805 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9806 @end itemize
9807
9808 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9809 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9810 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9811 to manually reset the peripherals.
9812 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9813
9814 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9815 instead.
9816 @end deffn
9817
9818 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9819 @cindex ARMv8-A
9820 @cindex aarch64
9821
9822 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9823 Display information about target caches
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9827 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9828 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9829 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9830 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9831 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9832 @end deffn
9833
9834 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9835 @cindex disassemble
9836 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9837 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9838 @end deffn
9839
9840 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9841 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9842 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9843 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9844 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9845 @end deffn
9846
9847 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9848 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9849 @option{on}.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9853 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9854 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9855 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9856 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9857 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9858 @end deffn
9859
9860 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9861
9862 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9863 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9864
9865 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9866
9867 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9868 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9869 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9870 @end deffn
9871
9872 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9873 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9874 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9875 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9876 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9877 @end deffn
9878
9879 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9880
9881 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9882 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9883 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9884 @end deffn
9885
9886 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9887
9888 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9889 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9890 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9891 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9892 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9893 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9894 can be collected.
9895
9896 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9897 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9898 tooling.
9899
9900 @quotation Issues
9901 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9902 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9903 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9904 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9905
9906 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9907 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9908 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9909 software operation on the CPU.
9910 @end quotation
9911
9912 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9913 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9914 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9915 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9919 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9920 @end deffn
9921
9922 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9923 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9924 control is disabled.
9925 @end deffn
9926
9927 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9928 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9929 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9930 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9931
9932 Supported trace formats:
9933 @itemize
9934 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9935 timing to be determined.
9936 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9937 addresses.
9938 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9939 @end itemize
9940 @end deffn
9941
9942 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9943 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9944 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9945 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9946
9947 Supported conditions:
9948 @itemize
9949 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9950 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9951 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9952 instruction matches start data and mask.
9953 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9954 instruction matches start data and mask.
9955 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9956 data and mask.
9957 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9958 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9959 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9960 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9961 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9962 @end itemize
9963 @end deffn
9964
9965 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9966 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9967 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9968 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9969
9970 Supported conditions:
9971 @itemize
9972 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9973 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9974 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9975 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9976 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9977 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9978 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9979 data and mask.
9980 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9981 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9982 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9983 @end itemize
9984 @end deffn
9985
9986 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9987 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9988
9989 Supported triggers:
9990 @itemize
9991 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9992 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9993 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9994 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9995 collection.
9996 @end itemize
9997 @end deffn
9998
9999 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10000
10001 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
10002 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10003 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10004 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10005 @end deffn
10006
10007 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
10008 Display trace configuration.
10009 @end deffn
10010
10011 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
10012 Display trace collection status.
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
10016 Start manual trace collection.
10017 @end deffn
10018
10019 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
10020 Stop manual trace collection.
10021 @end deffn
10022
10023 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10024 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10025 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10026 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10027 @option{size} options using DMA.
10028 @end deffn
10029
10030 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10031 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10032 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10033 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10034 @option{size} options using DMA.
10035 @end deffn
10036
10037 @section Intel Architecture
10038
10039 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10040 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10041 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10042 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10043 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10044 @itemize
10045 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10046 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10047 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10048 @end itemize
10049
10050 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10051 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10052 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10053
10054 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
10055 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10056 @end deffn
10057
10058 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
10059 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10060 @end deffn
10061
10062 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
10063 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
10067 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10068 @end deffn
10069
10070 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
10071 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10072 @end deffn
10073
10074 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
10075 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10076 @end deffn
10077
10078 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10079
10080 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10081 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10082
10083 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10084 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10085 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10086 @end deffn
10087 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10088 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10089
10090 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10091
10092 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10093 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10094 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10095 @end deffn
10096
10097 @subsection Registers commands
10098 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10099 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10100 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10101
10102 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10103
10104 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10105 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10106 and "timer" groups.
10107
10108 @emph{example:}
10109 @example
10110 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10111 @end example
10112
10113
10114 @end deffn
10115 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
10116 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
10117
10118 @emph{group} can be "system",
10119 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
10120 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
10121 @end deffn
10122
10123 @section RISC-V Architecture
10124
10125 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10126 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10127 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10128 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10129 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10130 implement version 0.11.
10131
10132 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10133
10134 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10135 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10136 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10137
10138 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10139
10140 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10141 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10142 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10143
10144 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10145 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10146 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10147 CSRs.
10148 @end deffn
10149
10150 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10151 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10152 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10153 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10154 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10155 This command must be executed before `init`.
10156 @end deffn
10157
10158 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10159 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10160 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10161 @end deffn
10162
10163 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10164 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10165 deasserted.
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10169 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10170 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10171 @end deffn
10172
10173 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10174 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10175 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10176 @end deffn
10177
10178 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10179 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10180 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10181 on physical memory.
10182 @end deffn
10183
10184 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10185 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10186 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10187 performed on physical memory.
10188 @end deffn
10189
10190 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10191 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10192 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10193 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10194 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10195 race condition problem in your code.
10196
10197 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10198 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10199 @end deffn
10200
10201 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10202 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10203 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10204 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10205 values.
10206
10207 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10208 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10209 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10210 @end deffn
10211
10212 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10213 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10214 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10218 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10219 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10220 @end deffn
10221
10222 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10223 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10224 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10225 @end deffn
10226
10227 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10228 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10229 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10233
10234 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10235 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10236 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10237 @example
10238 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10239 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10240 @end example
10241
10242 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
10243 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10244 @end deffn
10245
10246 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
10247 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10248 @end deffn
10249
10250 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10251
10252 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10253 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10254
10255 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
10256 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10257 @end deffn
10258
10259 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
10260 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10261 @end deffn
10262
10263 @section ARC Architecture
10264 @cindex ARC
10265
10266 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10267 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10268 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10269 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10270 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10271 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10272 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10273 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10274 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10275 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10276 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10277 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10278 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10279 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10280 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10281
10282
10283 @subsection General ARC commands
10284
10285 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10286
10287 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10288 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10289 arguments:
10290
10291 @itemize @bullet
10292
10293 @item @code{-name} name
10294 @*Name of a register.
10295
10296 @item @code{-num} number
10297 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10298
10299 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10300 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10301
10302 @end itemize
10303
10304 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10305
10306 @itemize @bullet
10307
10308 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10309 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10310 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10311 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10312 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10313 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10314
10315 @item @code{-core}
10316 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10317 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10318 spaces.
10319
10320 @item @code{-bcr}
10321 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10322 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10323 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10324 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10325 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10326
10327 @item @code{-type} type_name
10328 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10329 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10330
10331 @item @code{-g}
10332 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10333 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10334 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10335 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10336 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10337
10338 @end itemize
10339
10340 @end deffn
10341
10342 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10343 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10344 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10345 @end deffn
10346
10347 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10348 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10349 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10350 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10351 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10352 startbit endbit}.
10353 @end deffn
10354
10355 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10356 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10357 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10358 @end deffn
10359
10360 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10361 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10362 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10363 @end deffn
10364
10365 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10366
10367 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10368 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10369 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10370 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10371
10372 @end deffn
10373
10374 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10375 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10376 registers.
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10380 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10381 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10382 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10383
10384 @end deffn
10385
10386 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10387 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10388 registers.
10389 @end deffn
10390
10391 @section STM8 Architecture
10392 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10393 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10394
10395 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10396 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10397
10398 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10399 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10400 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10401 @cindex tracing
10402 @cindex libdcc
10403 @cindex DCC
10404 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10405 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10406 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10407 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10408
10409 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10410 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10411 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10412 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10413 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10414 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10415
10416 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10417 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10418 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10419 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10420 The target being debugged may
10421 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10422 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10423 each supported by a command:
10424
10425 @itemize
10426 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10427 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10428 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10429 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10430
10431 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10432 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10433 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10434
10435 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10436 and then displayed at any time.
10437 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10438
10439 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10440 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10441 @end itemize
10442
10443 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10444 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10445 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10446 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10447 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10448 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10449 does the same thing.
10450
10451 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10452 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10453 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10454 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10455 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10456
10457 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10458 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10459 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10460 @end deffn
10461
10462 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10463 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10464 in the order they triggered.
10465 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10466 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10467 history records.
10468 @end deffn
10469
10470 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10471 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10472 they have been triggered.
10473 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10474 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10475 and associates it with that identifier.
10476
10477 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10478 are not related except by this command.
10479 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10480 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10481 @end deffn
10482
10483
10484 @node JTAG Commands
10485 @chapter JTAG Commands
10486 @cindex JTAG Commands
10487 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10488 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10489 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10490 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10491 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10492
10493 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10494 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10495
10496 @itemize @bullet
10497 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10498 devices such as a CPUs.
10499 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10500 standard state machine (in parallel)
10501 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10502 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10503 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10504 while the reading previous ones.
10505 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10506 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10507 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10508 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10509 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10510 registers.
10511 @end itemize
10512
10513 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10514
10515 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10516 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10517 the order of TAP state transitions.
10518 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10519 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10520 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10521 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10522 these commands are not available.
10523
10524 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10525 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10526 that specify the entire register.
10527 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10528 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10529 The return value holds the original value of each
10530 of those fields.
10531
10532 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10533 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10534 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10535 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10536 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10537
10538 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10539 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10540
10541 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10542 in that state.
10543 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10544 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10545 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10546
10547 @quotation Warning
10548 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10549 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10550 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10551 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10552 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10553 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10554 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10555 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10556 @end quotation
10557 @end deffn
10558
10559 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10560 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10561 This may be used for performance tuning.
10562
10563 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10564 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10565 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10566 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10567 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10568 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10569 @end deffn
10570
10571 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10572 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10573 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10574 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10575 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10576 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10577
10578 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10579 in that state.
10580 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10581 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10582 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10583
10584 @quotation Note
10585 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10586 register values, unlike data register values.
10587 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10588 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10589 @end quotation
10590 @end deffn
10591
10592 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10593 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10594 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10595 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10596 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10597 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10598 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10599 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10600 The final state must also be stable.
10601 @end deffn
10602
10603 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10604 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10605 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10606 Instructions often need some time
10607 to execute before they take effect.
10608 @end deffn
10609
10610 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10611 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10612
10613 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10614 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10615 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10616 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10617 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10618 @end deffn
10619
10620 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10621 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10622 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10623 must also be enabled.
10624 Default is enabled.
10625 @end deffn
10626
10627 @section TAP state names
10628 @cindex TAP state names
10629
10630 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10631 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10632 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10633 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10634
10635 @itemize @bullet
10636 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10637 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10638 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10639 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10640 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10641 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10642 through the data register
10643 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10644 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10645 for update or more shifting
10646 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10647 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10648 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10649 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10650 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10651 through the instruction register
10652 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10653 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10654 for update or more shifting
10655 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10656 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10657 @end itemize
10658
10659 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10660 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10661 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10662 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10663
10664 @itemize @bullet
10665 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10666 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10667 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10668 may not be as expected.
10669 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10670 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10671 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10672 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10673 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10674 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10675 @end itemize
10676
10677 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10678 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10679
10680 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10681 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10682 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10683 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10684
10685 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10686 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10687 @cindex SVF
10688
10689 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10690 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10691 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10692 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10693
10694 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10695 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10696 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10697 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10698
10699 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10700 affect their semantics.
10701
10702 Command options:
10703 @itemize @minus
10704 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10705 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10706 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10707 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10708 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10709 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10710 on the real interface;
10711 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10712 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10713 errors.
10714 @end itemize
10715 @end deffn
10716
10717 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10718 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10719 @cindex XSVF
10720
10721 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10722 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10723 Xilinx devices.
10724 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10725 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10726
10727 @quotation Important
10728 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10729 @end quotation
10730
10731 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10732 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10733 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10734 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10735 that TAP.
10736 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10737 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10738 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10739 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10740 @end deffn
10741
10742 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10743 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10744 after building the software.
10745 You may find them useful:
10746
10747 @itemize
10748 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10749 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10750 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10751 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10752 @end itemize
10753
10754 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10755 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10756 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10757 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10758 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10759 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10760 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10761
10762
10763 @node Utility Commands
10764 @chapter Utility Commands
10765 @cindex Utility Commands
10766
10767 @section RAM testing
10768 @cindex RAM testing
10769
10770 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10771 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10772 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10773 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10774 hardware problems.
10775
10776 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10777 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10778 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10779 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10780
10781 Load the memory testing functions with
10782
10783 @example
10784 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10785 @end example
10786
10787 to get access to the following facilities:
10788
10789 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10790 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10791 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10792 @end deffn
10793
10794 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10795 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10796 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10797 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10798 @end deffn
10799
10800 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10801 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10802 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10803 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10804 @end deffn
10805
10806 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10807 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10808 @end deffn
10809
10810 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10811 @cindex Firmware recovery
10812
10813 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10814 devices recovery with JTAG.
10815
10816 For quickstart instructions run:
10817 @example
10818 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10819 @end example
10820
10821 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10822 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10823 @cindex GDB
10824 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10825 to debug remote targets.
10826 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10827
10828 @itemize
10829 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10830 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10831 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10832 as shown in this chapter.
10833 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10834 that also will probably need to be configured.
10835 @end itemize
10836
10837 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10838 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10839 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10840 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10841 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10842 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10843
10844 @section Connecting to GDB
10845 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10846 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10847 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10848 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10849 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10850
10851 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10852
10853 @enumerate
10854 @item
10855 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10856 @example
10857 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10858 @end example
10859 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10860
10861 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10862 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10863 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10864
10865 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10866 remote command above that becomes:
10867 @example
10868 tar ext :3333
10869 @end example
10870
10871 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10872 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10873 available through the command:
10874 @example
10875 target remote localhost:3333
10876 @end example
10877
10878 @item
10879 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10880 @example
10881 target extended-remote | \
10882 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10883 @end example
10884 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10885 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10886 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10887 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10888 @end enumerate
10889
10890 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10891 GDB command line.
10892
10893 @section Sample GDB session startup
10894
10895 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10896 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10897 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10898 small ARM program.
10899 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10900 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10901
10902 @example
10903 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10904 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10905 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10906 ...
10907 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10908 ...
10909 (gdb) load
10910 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10911 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10912 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10913 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10914 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10915 (gdb) continue
10916 Continuing.
10917 ...
10918 @end example
10919
10920 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10921 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10922 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10923 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10924
10925 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10926
10927 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10928 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10929 packet size and the device's memory map.
10930 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10931 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10932 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10933
10934 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10935 You may need to set those up by hand.
10936 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10937 something like:
10938
10939 @example
10940 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10941 @end example
10942
10943 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10944
10945 @example
10946 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10947 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10948 @end example
10949
10950 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10951 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10952 do not have such restrictions.
10953
10954 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10955 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10956 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10957 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10958
10959 @section Programming using GDB
10960 @cindex Programming using GDB
10961 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10962
10963 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10964 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10965 @example
10966 gdb_memory_map disable
10967 @end example
10968 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10969 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10970 working area.
10971
10972 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10973 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10974 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10975 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10976
10977 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10978 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10979
10980 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10981 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10982 @example
10983 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10984 @end example
10985
10986 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10987 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10988
10989 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10990 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10991 will be used.
10992
10993 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10994 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10995 @example
10996 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10997 @end example
10998 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10999
11000 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11001 can be used.
11002
11003 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11004 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11005 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11006
11007 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11008 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11009 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11010
11011 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11012 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11013 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11014 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11015 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11016 without any intrusion of the target process.
11017
11018 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11019 Place following command after target configuration:
11020 @example
11021 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11022 @end example
11023
11024 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11025 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11026 @example
11027 gdb_memory_map disable
11028 @end example
11029
11030 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11031 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11032 @example
11033 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11034 @end example
11035
11036 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11037 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11038
11039 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11040 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11041 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11042 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11043
11044 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11045 previously shown variables.
11046
11047 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11048 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11049 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11050 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11051 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11052
11053 @section RTOS Support
11054 @cindex RTOS Support
11055 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11056
11057 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11058 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11059
11060 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11061 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11062 GDB commands.
11063
11064 @* An example setup is below:
11065
11066 @example
11067 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11068 @end example
11069
11070 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11071
11072 Currently supported rtos's include:
11073 @itemize @bullet
11074 @item @option{eCos}
11075 @item @option{ThreadX}
11076 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11077 @item @option{linux}
11078 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11079 @item @option{embKernel}
11080 @item @option{mqx}
11081 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11082 @item @option{nuttx}
11083 @item @option{RIOT}
11084 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11085 @end itemize
11086
11087 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11088 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11089
11090 @table @code
11091 @item eCos symbols
11092 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11093 @item ThreadX symbols
11094 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11095 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11096 @raggedright
11097 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11098 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11099 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11100 @end raggedright
11101 @item linux symbols
11102 init_task.
11103 @item ChibiOS symbols
11104 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11105 @item embKernel symbols
11106 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11107 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11108 @item mqx symbols
11109 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11110 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11111 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11112 @item nuttx symbols
11113 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11114 @item RIOT symbols
11115 @raggedright
11116 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11117 _tcb_name_offset.
11118 @end raggedright
11119 @end table
11120
11121 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11122 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
11123
11124 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11125 along with the project:
11126
11127 @table @code
11128 @item FreeRTOS
11129 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11130 @item uC/OS-III
11131 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11132 @end table
11133
11134 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11135 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11136 @cindex SMP
11137 @cindex RTOS
11138 @cindex hwthread
11139 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11140 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11141 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11142 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11143 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11144 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11145 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11146 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11147 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11148
11149 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11150 @quotation Note
11151 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11152 @end quotation
11153
11154 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11155 @itemize @bullet
11156 @item j - smp status request
11157 @item J - smp set request
11158 @end itemize
11159
11160 OpenOCD implements :
11161 @itemize @bullet
11162 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11163 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11164 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11165 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11166 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11167 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11168 @end itemize
11169
11170 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11171 @itemize @bullet
11172 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11173 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11174 @example
11175 set $_core 1
11176 #Jc01 packet is sent
11177 print $_core
11178 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11179 @end example
11180
11181 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11182 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11183
11184 @example
11185 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11186 define toggle0
11187 maint packet Jc0
11188 continue
11189 main packet Jc-1
11190 end
11191 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11192 define toggle1
11193 maint packet Jc1
11194 continue
11195 main packet Jc-1
11196 end
11197 @end example
11198 @end itemize
11199
11200 @node Tcl Scripting API
11201 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11202 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11203 @cindex Tcl scripts
11204 @section API rules
11205
11206 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11207 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11208 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11209
11210 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11211 pair list and lists.
11212
11213 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11214 list.
11215
11216 @example
11217 > set foo(me) Duane
11218 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11219 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11220 > set foo(duck) Donald
11221 @end example
11222
11223 If one does this:
11224
11225 @example
11226 > set foo
11227 @end example
11228
11229 The result is:
11230
11231 @example
11232 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11233 @end example
11234
11235 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11236
11237 @verbatim
11238 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11239 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11240 }
11241 @end verbatim
11242
11243 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11244 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11245
11246 @section Internal low-level Commands
11247
11248 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11249 invoke directly.
11250
11251 @itemize @bullet
11252 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11253
11254 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11255 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11256
11257 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11258 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11259
11260 Return information about the flash banks
11261
11262 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11263
11264 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11265 its execution. Example:
11266
11267 @example
11268 > capture "reset init"
11269 @end example
11270
11271 @end itemize
11272
11273 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11274 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11275 called "flash_banks".
11276
11277 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11278
11279 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11280 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11281 holds one of the following values:
11282
11283 @itemize @bullet
11284 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11285 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11286 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11287 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11288 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11289 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11290 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11291 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11292 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11293 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11294 @end itemize
11295
11296 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11297
11298 @quotation Note
11299 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11300 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11301 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11302 is jim, not real tcl).
11303 @end quotation
11304
11305 @section Tcl RPC server
11306 @cindex RPC
11307
11308 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11309 commands and receive the results.
11310
11311 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11312 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11313 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11314 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11315 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11316
11317 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11318 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11319 @command{capture} command.
11320
11321 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11322
11323 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11324 @cindex RPC Notifications
11325
11326 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11327 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11328
11329 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11330 in the following format.
11331
11332 @verbatim
11333 type target_event event [event-name]
11334 type target_state state [state-name]
11335 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11336 @end verbatim
11337
11338 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11339 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11340 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11341 Defaults to off.
11342
11343 @end deffn
11344
11345 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11346 @cindex RPC trace output
11347
11348 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11349 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11350
11351 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11352
11353 @verbatim
11354 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11355 @end verbatim
11356
11357 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11358 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11359 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11360 Defaults to off.
11361
11362 See an example application here:
11363 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11364
11365 @end deffn
11366
11367 @node FAQ
11368 @chapter FAQ
11369 @cindex faq
11370 @enumerate
11371 @anchor{faqrtck}
11372 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11373 @cindex RTCK
11374 @cindex adaptive clocking
11375 @*
11376
11377 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11378 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11379 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11380 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11381
11382 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11383 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11384 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11385 @enumerate
11386 @item
11387 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11388 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11389 @item
11390 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11391 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11392 @end enumerate
11393
11394 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11395 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11396 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11397 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11398 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11399 power).
11400
11401 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11402 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11403 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11404 ARM926 scenario).
11405 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11406 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11407 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11408
11409 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11410 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11411 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11412 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11413
11414 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11415
11416 In order to make use of this,
11417 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11418 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11419
11420 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11421 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11422 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11423 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11424 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11425
11426 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11427 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11428 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11429 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11430
11431 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11432 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11433 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11434 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11435 with a CPLD.
11436 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11437 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11438 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11439 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11440 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11441 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11442
11443 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11444
11445 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11446
11447 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11448 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11449 depending on the chips on your board.
11450 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11451 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11452 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11453
11454 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11455 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11456 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11457
11458 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11459 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11460 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11461 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11462
11463 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11464 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11465 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11466 this way.
11467
11468 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11469 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11470 clock rate.
11471 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11472 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11473 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11474
11475 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11476
11477 @example
11478 # Example: 1.234MHz
11479 adapter speed 1234
11480 @end example
11481
11482
11483 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11484
11485 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11486 around Windows filenames.
11487
11488 @example
11489 > echo \a
11490
11491 > echo @{\a@}
11492 \a
11493 > echo "\a"
11494
11495 >
11496 @end example
11497
11498
11499 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11500
11501 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11502 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11503 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11504
11505 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11506 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11507 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11508
11509 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11510 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11511 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11512
11513 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11514
11515 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11516 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11517 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11518 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11519
11520 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11521 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11522 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11523
11524 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11525 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11526
11527 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11528 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11529 memory read caused data abort".
11530
11531 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11532 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11533 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11534 be done, feel free to add this here.
11535
11536 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11537 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11538 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11539 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11540 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11541 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11542 gracefully stops.
11543
11544 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11545 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11546 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11547
11548 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11549 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11550 bytes. Painful...
11551
11552
11553 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11554 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11555
11556 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11557 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11558 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11559 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11560 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11561 reset, everything else should work fine.
11562
11563 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11564 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11565 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11566 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11567
11568 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11569 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11570 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11571 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11572
11573 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11574
11575 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11576 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11577 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11578
11579 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11580 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11581
11582 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11583 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11584 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11585 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11586 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11587 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11588 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11589 clock frequency?
11590
11591 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11592 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11593 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11594 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11595 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11596
11597 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11598
11599 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11600 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11601 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11602 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11603 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11604 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11605 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11606
11607 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11608
11609 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11610 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11611 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11612 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11613
11614 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11615 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11616 particular order?
11617
11618 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11619 the same order used by the hardware.
11620
11621 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11622 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11623 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11624 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11625 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11626 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11627
11628 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11629 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11630 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11631 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11632
11633 @itemize @bullet
11634 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11635 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11636 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11637 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11638 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11639 @end itemize
11640
11641 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11642
11643 @itemize @bullet
11644 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11645 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11646 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11647 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11648 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11649 @end itemize
11650
11651
11652 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11653 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11654 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11655
11656 TODO.
11657
11658 @end enumerate
11659
11660 @node Tcl Crash Course
11661 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11662 @cindex Tcl
11663
11664 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11665 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11666 how the Tcl scripts work.
11667
11668 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11669 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11670 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11671 OpenOCD.
11672
11673 @section Tcl Rule #1
11674 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11675 @enumerate
11676 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11677 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11678 @end enumerate
11679
11680 The Tcl equal is this:
11681
11682 @enumerate
11683 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11684 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11685 @end enumerate
11686
11687 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11688 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11689
11690 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11691 There is a second pair of rules.
11692 @enumerate
11693 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11694 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11695 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11696 in Tcl.
11697 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11698 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11699 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11700 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11701 @end enumerate
11702
11703 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11704 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11705 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11706 Everything is a string}
11707
11708 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11709 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11710 difference is subtle.
11711 @enumerate
11712 @item Parse Time
11713 @item Evaluation Time
11714 @end enumerate
11715
11716 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11717 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11718 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11719
11720 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11721 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11722 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11723 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11724
11725 @itemize @bullet
11726 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11727 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11728 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11729 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11730 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11731 @example
11732 # bash example
11733 X=`date`
11734 echo "The Date is: $X"
11735 # Tcl example
11736 set X [date]
11737 puts "The Date is: $X"
11738 @end example
11739 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11740 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11741 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11742 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11743 is a string}
11744 @example
11745 set x "Dinner"
11746 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11747 @end example
11748 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11749 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11750 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11751 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11752 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11753 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11754 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11755 @end itemize
11756
11757 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11758
11759 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11760
11761 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11762
11763 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11764 the normal way.
11765
11766 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11767 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11768 line is immediately executed.
11769
11770 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11771 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11772
11773 @subsection Command Execution
11774
11775 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11776 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11777 control flow operators.
11778
11779 Commands are executed like this:
11780
11781 @enumerate
11782 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11783 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11784 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11785 @end enumerate
11786
11787 It sort of works like this:
11788 @example
11789 for(;;)@{
11790 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11791
11792 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11793
11794 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11795 @}
11796 @end example
11797
11798 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11799 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11800 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11801 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11802 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11803 ``LookupCommand()''
11804
11805 @subsection The FOR command
11806
11807 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11808 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11809 command just like any other command.
11810
11811 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11812 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11813 are:
11814
11815 @enumerate 0
11816 @item The ascii text 'for'
11817 @item The start text
11818 @item The test expression
11819 @item The next text
11820 @item The body text
11821 @end enumerate
11822
11823 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11824 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11825 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11826 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11827
11828 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11829 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11830
11831 @example
11832 int
11833 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11834 int *argc,
11835 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11836 @end example
11837
11838 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11839 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11840 still operates in the same basic way.
11841
11842 @subsection FOR command implementation
11843
11844 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11845 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11846
11847 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11848
11849 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11850
11851 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11852 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11853 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11854
11855 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11856 expression and returns a value.
11857
11858 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11859 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11860 @example
11861 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11862
11863 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11864
11865 int
11866 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11867 int argc,
11868 char **argv )
11869 @{
11870 if( argc != 5 )@{
11871 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11872 return ERROR;
11873 @}
11874
11875 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11876
11877 // Execute the start statement.
11878 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11879
11880 // Top of loop test
11881 for(;;)@{
11882 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11883 if( i == 0 )
11884 break;
11885
11886 // Execute the body
11887 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11888
11889 // Execute the LOOP part
11890 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11891 @}
11892
11893 // Return no error
11894 SetResult( interp, "" );
11895 return SUCCESS;
11896 @}
11897 @end example
11898
11899 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11900 in the same basic way.
11901
11902 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11903
11904 @subsection source and find commands
11905 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11906 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11907 @*Remember the parsing rules
11908 @enumerate
11909 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11910 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11911 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11912 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11913 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11914 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11915 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11916 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11917 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11918 @end enumerate
11919 @subsection format command
11920 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11921 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11922 @b{sprintf()}.
11923 @b{Example}
11924 @example
11925 set x 6
11926 set y 7
11927 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11928 @end example
11929 @enumerate
11930 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11931 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11932 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11933 @* Refer to Rule #1
11934 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11935 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11936 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11937 @end enumerate
11938 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11939 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11940 @example
11941 #1 Good
11942 proc someproc @{@} @{
11943 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11944 @}
11945 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11946 #2 Good - no variables
11947 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11948 #3 Good Curly Braces
11949 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11950 puts "Time: [date]"
11951 @}
11952 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11953 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11954 @end example
11955 @enumerate
11956 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11957 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11958 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11959 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11960 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11961 command.
11962 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11963 @*There are 4 examples:
11964 @enumerate
11965 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11966 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11967 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11968 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11969 @end enumerate
11970
11971 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11972 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11973 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11974
11975 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11976 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11977 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11978 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11979 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11980 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11981 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11982 @end enumerate
11983 @subsection Global Variables
11984 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11985 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11986 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11987 @example
11988 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11989 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11990 global x #Global variable X
11991 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11992 @}
11993 @end example
11994 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11995 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11996 @example
11997 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11998 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11999 # Create var name
12000 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12001 # Make it a global
12002 global $vn
12003 # Set it.
12004 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12005 @}
12006 @end example
12007 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12008 @example
12009 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12010 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12011 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12012 @}
12013 @end example
12014
12015 @include fdl.texi
12016
12017 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12018 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12019 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12020 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12021 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12022 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12023
12024 @printindex cp
12025
12026 @node Command and Driver Index
12027 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12028 @printindex fn
12029
12030 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)